Yamaha pf50 Handleiding

Categorie
Digitale piano's
Type
Handleiding

Deze handleiding is ook geschikt voor

DIC 338
Yamaha Web Site (English only)
www.yamahasynth.com
Yamaha Manual Library
http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/
M.D.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation
C
2002 Yamaha Corporation
V941880 205APAP1.3-01A0 Printed in Japan
This document is printed on recycled chlorine free (ECF) paper with soy ink.
IMPORTANT
Check your power supply
Make sure that your local AC mains voltage matches the voltage specified on the name plate
on the bottom panel. In some areas a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of
the main keyboard unit. Make sure that the voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. The
voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped. To change the setting use a
"minus" screwdriver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage appears next to the
pointer on the panel.
Before using the PF-500, be sure to read
Precautions on pages 3-4.
PF-500
PF-500
Owner's Manual
2
PF-500
SPECIAL MESSAGE SECTION
PRODUCT SAFETY MARKINGS:
Yamaha electronic
products may have either labels similar to the graphics
shown below or molded/stamped facsimiles of these
graphics on the enclosure. The explanation of these
graphics appears on this page. Please observe all cautions
indicated on this page and those indicated in the safety
instruction section.
See bottom of Keyboard enclosure for graphic symbol markings
The exclamation point within the
equilateral triangle is intended to alert
the user to the presence of important
operating and maintenance (servic-
ing) instructions in the literature
accompanying the product.
The lightning flash with arrowhead
symbol, within the equilateral trian-
gle, is intended to alert the user to the
presence of uninsulated “dangerous
voltage” within the product’s enclo-
sure that may be of sufficient magni-
tude to constitute a risk of electrical
shock.
IMPORTANT NOTICE:
All Yamaha electronic products
are tested and approved by an independent safety testing
laboratory in order that you may be sure that when it is
properly installed and used in its normal and customary
manner, all foreseeable risks have been eliminated. DO
NOT modify this unit or commission others to do so
unless specifically authorized by Yamaha. Product perfor-
mance and/or safety standards may be diminished.
Claims filed under the expressed warranty may be denied
if the unit is/has been modified. Implied warranties may
also be affected.
SPECIFICATIONS SUBJECT TO CHANGE:
The
information contained in this manual is believed to be
correct at the time of printing. However, Yamaha reserves
the right to change or modify any of the specifications
without notice or obligation to update existing units.
ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES:
Yamaha strives to pro-
duce products that are both user safe and environmentally
friendly. We sincerely believe that our products and the
production methods used to produce them, meet these
goals. In keeping with both the letter and the spirit of the
law, we want you to be aware of the following:
Battery Notice:
This product MAY contain a small non-
rechargable battery which (if applicable) is soldered in
place. The average life span of this type of battery is
approximately five years. When replacement becomes
necessary, contact a qualified service representative to
perform the replacement.
Warning:
Do not attempt to recharge, disassemble, or
incinerate this type of battery. Keep all batteries away
from children. Dispose of used batteries promptly and as
regulated by applicable laws. Note: In some areas, the
servicer is required by law to return the defective parts.
However, you do have the option of having the servicer
dispose of these parts for you.
Disposal Notice:
Should this product become damaged
beyond repair, or for some reason its useful life is consid-
ered to be at an end, please observe all local, state, and
federal regulations that relate to the disposal of products
that contain lead, batteries, plastics, etc.
NOTICE:
Service charges incurred due to lack of knowl-
edge relating to how a function or effect works (when the
unit is operating as designed) are not covered by the man-
ufacturer’s warranty, and are therefore the owners respon-
sibility. Please study this manual carefully and consult
your dealer before requesting service.
NAME PLATE LOCATION:
The graphic below indi-
cates the location of the name plate. The model number,
serial number, power requirements, etc., are located on
this plate. You should record the model number, serial
number, and the date of purchase in the spaces provided
below and retain this manual as a permanent record of
your purchase.
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK.
DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK).
NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE.
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
Model
Serial No.
Purchase Date
PF-500
92-469
1
Introduction
PF-500
3
PRECAUTIONS
PLEASE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING
* Please keep this manual in a safe place for future reference.
WARNING
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of serious injury or even death
from electrical shock, short-circuiting, damages, fire or other hazards. These precautions include, but
are not limited to, the following:
Only use the voltage specified as correct for the instrument.
The required voltage is printed on the name plate of the
instrument.
Check the electric plug periodically and remove any dirt or
dust which may have accumulated on it.
Use only the supplied power cord/plug.
Do not place the power cord near heat sources such as
heaters or radiators, and do not excessively bend or otherwise
damage the cord, place heavy objects on it, or place it in a
position where anyone could walk on, trip over, or roll anything
over it.
Do not open the instrument or attempt to disassemble the
internal parts or modify them in any way. The instrument
contains no user-serviceable parts. If it should appear to be
malfunctioning, discontinue use immediately and have it
inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
Do not expose the instrument to rain, use it near water or in
damp or wet conditions, or place containers on it containing
liquids which might spill into any openings.
Never insert or remove an electric plug with wet hands.
Do not put burning items, such as candles, on the unit.
A burning item may fall over and cause a fire.
If the power cord or plug becomes frayed or damaged, or if
there is a sudden loss of sound during use of the instrument,
or if any unusual smells or smoke should appear to be caused
by it, immediately turn off the power switch, disconnect the
electric plug from the outlet, and have the instrument
inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel.
CAUTION
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of physical injury to you or
others, or damage to the instrument or other property. These precautions include, but are not limited
to, the following:
When removing the electric plug from the instrument or an
outlet, always hold the plug itself and not the cord. Pulling by
the cord can damage it.
Remove the electric plug from the outlet when the instrument
is not to be used for extended periods of time, or during
electrical storms.
Do not connect the instrument to an electrical outlet using a
multiple-connector. Doing so can result in lower sound quality,
or possibly cause overheating in the outlet.
Read carefully this manual or the attached documentation
explaining the assembly process. Failure to assemble the
stand in the proper sequence might result in damage to the
instrument or even injury.
Do not expose the instrument to excessive dust or vibrations,
or extreme cold or heat (such as in direct sunlight, near a
heater, or in a car during the day) to prevent the possibility of
panel disfiguration or damage to the internal components.
Do not use the instrument in the vicinity of a TV, radio, stereo
equipment, mobile phone, or other electric devices.
Otherwise, the instrument, TV, or radio may generate noise.
Do not place the instrument in an unstable position where it
might accidentally fall over.
Before moving the instrument, remove all connected cables.
Do not place objects in front of the instrument’s air vent, since
this may prevent adequate ventilation of the internal
components, and possibly result in the instrument
overheating.
Power supply/Power cord
Do not open
Water warning
Fire warning
If you notice any abnormality
Power supply/Power cord
Assembling the keyboard stand
Location
(1)B-7
1/2
4
PF-500
Before connecting the instrument to other electronic
components, turn off the power for all components. Before
turning the power on or off for all components, set all volume
levels to minimum. Also, be sure to set the volumes of all
components at their minimum levels and gradually raise the
volume controls while playing the instrument to set the desired
listening level.
When cleaning the instrument, use a soft, dry or slightly damp
cloth. Do not use paint thinners, solvents, cleaning fluids, or
chemical-impregnated wiping cloths.
Never insert or drop paper, metallic, or other objects into the
gaps on the panel or keyboard. If this happens, turn off the
power immediately and unplug the power cord from the AC
outlet. Then have the instrument inspected by qualified
Yamaha service personnel.
Do not place vinyl, plastic or rubber objects on the instrument,
since this might discolor the panel or keyboard.
Do not rest your weight on, or place heavy objects on the
instrument, and do not use excessive force on the buttons,
switches or connectors.
Do not operate the instrument for a long period of time at a
high or uncomfortable volume level, since this can cause
permanent hearing loss. If you experience any hearing loss or
ringing in the ears, consult a physician.
Do not place the bench in an unstable position where it might
accidentally fall over.
Do not play carelessly with or stand on the bench. Using it as
a tool or step-ladder or for any other purpose might result in
accident or injury.
Only one person should sit on the bench at a time, in order to
prevent the possibility of accident or injury.
If the bench screws become loose due to extensive long-term
use, tighten them periodically using the included tool.
Saving and backing up your data
Current data (see page 43) is lost when you turn off the power
to the instrument. Save the data to the storage memory (see
page 43).
Yamaha cannot be held responsible for damage caused by improper use or modifications to the instrument, or data that is lost or
destroyed.
Always turn the power off when the instrument is not in use.
Connections
Maintenance
Handling caution
Using the bench (If included)
Saving data
(1)B-7
2/2
PF-500
5
Thank you for choosing the Yamaha PF-500 electronic piano. In order to make the most of your
PF-500’s performance potential and features, please read this Owner’s Manual thoroughly, and
keep it in a safe place for later reference.
About this Owner’s Manual and Reference Booklet
This manual consists of four main sections: “Introduction, “Basic Operation, “Detailed Settings, and Appendix.
Also, a separate “Reference Booklet is provided.
Introduction:
Please read this section first. In the Application Index” section on page 9 and “Features on
page 12, you can learn how to use the PF-500 and its functions in particular situations.
Basic Operation:
This main section explains how to use the basic functions. Refer to this section while you
play the PF-500. If you have questions or come across the words you do not know, refer to
the section entitled “Questions about Operations and Functions on page 90, or the
“Index” on page 102.
Detailed Settings:
This section explains how to make detailed settings for the PF-500’s various functions.
Refer to this section as necessary.
Appendix:
This section introduces troubleshooting, a description of preset voices, and other reference
material.
Reference Booklet:
XG Voice List, MIDI Data Format, etc.
The illustrations and LCD screens as shown in this Owner’s Manual are for instructional purposes only,
and may appear somewhat different from those on your instrument.
Copying of the commercially available software is strictry prohibited except for your personal use.
Trademarks
Apple and Macintosh are trademarks of Apple Computer, Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Windows is the registered trademark of Microsoft® Corporation.
All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders.
COPYRIGHT NOTICE
This product incorporates and bundles computer programs and contents in which Yamaha owns copy-
rights or with respect to which it has license to use others’ copyrights. Such copyrighted materials include,
without limitation, all computer software, MIDI files, WAVE data and sound recordings. Any unauthorized
use of such programs and contents outside of personal use is not permitted under relevant laws. Any vio-
lation of copyright has legal consequences. DON’T MAKE, DISTRIBUTE OR USE ILLEGALCOPIES.
6
PF-500
Table of contents
Introduction.......................................................... 2
PRECAUTIONS ........................................................................................................................................ 3
About this Owner’s Manual and Reference Booklet..................................................................................................... 5
Table of contents ................................................................................................................................... 6
Application Index ................................................................................................................................... 9
Included Accessories ............................................................................................................................ 11
Features ................................................................................................................................................ 12
Before Using the PF-500 ...................................................................................................................... 14
About the pedal unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 14
About the music stand.................................................................................................................................................. 14
Turning the power on................................................................................................................................................... 15
Adjusting the display contrast ...................................................................................................................................... 16
Setting the volume ........................................................................................................................................................ 16
Using headphones......................................................................................................................................................... 16
Basic Operation .................................................. 17
Part Names ........................................................................................................................................... 18
Listening to the Demonstration Tunes................................................................................................ 20
Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs ..................................................................................................... 22
Playing the 50 piano preset songs ................................................................................................................................ 22
Practicing a one-hand part using 50 preset songs ....................................................................................................... 24
Selecting and Playing Voices ............................................................................................................... 26
Selecting Voices............................................................................................................................................................. 26
Using the pedals ............................................................................................................................................................ 27
Adding variation to the sound
[BRILLIANCE]/[REVERB]/[CHORUS] ..................................................................................................................... 28
Combining two voices (Dual mode)............................................................................................................................ 30
Splitting the keyboard range and playing two different voices (Split mode) ............................................................ 32
Using the metronome................................................................................................................................................... 34
Recording Your Performance............................................................................................................... 35
Recording a New Song.................................................................................................................................................. 35
Recording to [TRACK 1]........................................................................................................................................ 35
Re-recording TRACK 1........................................................................................................................................... 37
Re-recording TRACK 1 partially............................................................................................................................ 38
Recording to [TRACK2]......................................................................................................................................... 39
Recording to the third or more tracks [EXTRA TRACKS] .................................................................................. 40
Other recording techniques.......................................................................................................................................... 40
Adding data to or recording over an existing song ............................................................................................... 40
Changing a voice or tempo after recording ........................................................................................................... 41
Adjusting the volume balance between playback and your performance [SONG BALANCE] ......................... 42
Recording in Dual or Split mode ........................................................................................................................... 42
Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE] ...................................................................... 43
PF-500 memory....................................................................................................................................................... 43
Basic file operation.................................................................................................................................................. 44
Saving recorded or other songs to PF-500 Storage memory...[SaveToMemory]...................................................... 45
Deleting a Memory song...[DeleteSong]...................................................................................................................... 46
Table of contents
PF-500
7
Renaming a song...[RenameSong] ............................................................................................................................... 47
Changing the type of characters on screen...[CharacterCode]................................................................................... 47
Playing Back Recorded Songs .............................................................................................................. 48
Playing back a song ....................................................................................................................................................... 48
Turning track playback on and off............................................................................................................................... 50
Supported song data type ............................................................................................................................................. 50
Connections ......................................................................................................................................... 51
Connectors .................................................................................................................................................................... 51
Connecting a personal computer................................................................................................................................. 53
Detailed Settings ................................................ 59
Detailed Settings.................................................................................................................................. 60
Parameter List ............................................................................................................................................................... 60
Making detailed settings ............................................................................................................................................... 63
Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING] ........................................................ 65
Correcting note timing [Quantize].............................................................................................................................. 65
Specifying whether playback starts immediately along with the first voicing [QuickPlay]...................................... 66
Auditioning the channels [ChannelListen] ................................................................................................................. 66
Deleting data from each channel [ChannelClear]....................................................................................................... 66
Specifying the range and playing back repeatedly [FromToRepeat] ......................................................................... 66
Playing back the phrase specified by the phrase number [PhraseMark] ................................................................... 67
Playing back a song repeatedly [SongRepeat] ............................................................................................................. 67
Detailed settings for the metronome METRONOME [SETTING] ........................................................ 68
Setting the metronome time signature [TimeSignature]............................................................................................ 68
Setting the metronome volume level [MetronomeVolume]...................................................................................... 68
Selecting the metronome voice [MetronomeSound] ................................................................................................. 68
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] .............................................................................. 69
Setting the octave [Octave]........................................................................................................................................... 70
Setting the volume level [Volume] .............................................................................................................................. 70
Setting the position of right and left channels [Pan] .................................................................................................. 70
Make fine adjustments to the pitch (only in Dual mode) [Detune].......................................................................... 70
Selecting the reverb type [ReverbType]....................................................................................................................... 71
Setting the reverb depth [ReverbSend]........................................................................................................................ 71
Selecting the chorus type [Chorus Type]..................................................................................................................... 71
Setting the chorus depth [ChorusSend] ...................................................................................................................... 71
Setting the chorus on/off [ChorusOnOff]................................................................................................................... 72
Selecting the DSP type [DSP Type (DSP)] .................................................................................................................. 72
Setting the speed of the vibraphone vibrato effect [VibeRotorSpeed]....................................................................... 72
Turning the vibraphone vibrato effect on/off [VibeRotorOnOff (RotorOnOff)] .................................................... 73
Setting the rotation speed of the rotary speaker [RotarySpeed (Rot.Speed)]............................................................ 73
Adjusting the depth of the DSP effect [DSPDepth].................................................................................................... 73
Adjusting the brightness of the sound [Brightness].................................................................................................... 73
Adjusting the resonance effect [HarmonicContent (Harmonic)] ............................................................................. 73
Adjusting the low-range frequency of the equalizer [EQ LowFreq. (EQ L.Freq)] ....................................................74
Adjusting the low-range gain (amount of boost/cut) of the equalizer [EQ LowGain]............................................. 74
Adjusting the high-range frequency of the equalizer [EQ HighFreq. (EQ H.Freq)] ................................................ 74
Adjusting the high-range gain (amount of boost/cut) of the equalizer [EQ HighGain] .......................................... 74
Table of contents
8
PF-500
Setting the touch sensitivity [TouchSense].................................................................................................................. 75
Setting the right pedal function [RPedal].................................................................................................................... 75
Setting the center pedal function [MPedal] ................................................................................................................ 75
Setting the left pedal function [LPedal]....................................................................................................................... 76
Setting the auxiliary pedal function [AuxPedal] ......................................................................................................... 76
MIDI [MIDI SETTING]........................................................................................................................... 77
About MIDI................................................................................................................................................................... 77
Setting the MIDI transmit channel [MidiOutChannel] ............................................................................................. 78
Setting the MIDI receive channel [MidiInChannel]................................................................................................... 78
Setting Local control on/off [LocalControl]................................................................................................................ 79
Selecting performance from the keyboard or song data for MIDI transmission [MidiOutSelect].......................... 79
Selecting a type of data received via MIDI [ReceiveParameter]................................................................................. 79
Selecting a type of data transmitted via MIDI [TransmitParameter] ........................................................................ 79
Transmitting the initial settings on the panel [InitialSetup] ...................................................................................... 80
Executing voice data bulk dump [VoiceBulkDump].................................................................................................. 80
Other settings ...................................................................................................................................... 81
Selecting a touch response [TouchResponse] ............................................................................................................. 81
Fine tuning the pitch [Tune]........................................................................................................................................ 81
Selecting a tuning curve for a piano voice [PianoTuningCurve]............................................................................... 81
Selecting a scale [Scale]................................................................................................................................................. 82
Specifying the Split Point [SplitPoint]......................................................................................................................... 82
Changing the key [Transpose] ..................................................................................................................................... 82
Adjusting the depth of the Soft pedal [SoftPedalDepth] ............................................................................................ 83
Depth of string resonance [StringResonanceDepth] .................................................................................................. 83
Depth of sustain sampling for the damper pedal [SustainSamplingDepth].............................................................. 83
Specify the volume of the key-off sound [KeyOffSamplingDepth] ........................................................................... 83
Selecting a pedal function for vibraphone [VibraphonePedalMode]........................................................................ 83
Assign the SONG [START/STOP] function to the pedal [PedalStart/Stop]............................................................. 84
Selecting a type of auxiliary pedal [AuxPedalType].................................................................................................... 84
Setting the point at which the damper pedal starts to affect the sound [HalfPedalPoint] ....................................... 84
Pitch bend range [PitchBendRange]............................................................................................................................ 84
Switch the speaker on/off [Speaker] ............................................................................................................................ 85
Selecting items saved at shutdown [MemoryBackUp] ............................................................................................... 85
Restoring the normal (default) settings [FactorySet] ................................................................................................. 85
Other method for restoring the normal settings ......................................................................................................... 85
Message List ......................................................................................................................................... 86
Questions about Operations and Functions ........................................................................................90
Appendix ............................................................ 93
Troubleshooting................................................................................................................................... 94
Data Compatibility ............................................................................................................................... 95
Preset Voice List ................................................................................................................................... 97
Voice Combination Examples (Dual and Split) ................................................................................... 99
Assembling the Keyboard Stand ....................................................................................................... 100
Index................................................................................................................................................... 102
PF-500
9
Application Index
Use this index to find reference pages that may be helpful for your application and situation.
Listening
Listening to demo songs...............................................“Listening to the Demonstration Tunes” on page 20
“Playing the 50 piano preset songs on page 22
Listening to demo songs with different voices ............“Listening to the Demonstration Tunes” on page 20
Listening to songs from “50 greats for the Piano” ..............“Playing the 50 piano preset songs” on page 22
Listening to my recorded performance ............................................ “Recording to [TRACK 1]” on page 35
“Playing back a song” on page 48
Playing
Using three pedals.............................................................................................“Using the pedals” on page 27
Playing an accompaniment that matches pitch ....................... “Changing the key [Transpose]” on page 82
Changing tonal color
Viewing the list of voices.................................................................................. “Preset Voice List” on page 97
Simulating a concert hall...........................................................................................“[REVERB]” on page 29
Combining two voices..................................................... “Combining two voices (Dual mode)” on page 30
Playing different sounds with left and right hands
...........................“Splitting the keyboard range and playing two different voices (Split mode)” on page 32
Making a voice brighter and sharper, or softer and smoother ........................“[BRILLIANCE]” on page 28
Adding spread to the sound .................................................................................... “[CHORUS]” on page 29
Practicing
Muting the right- or left-hand part ........... “Practicing a one-hand part using 50 preset songs on page 24
Practicing with an accurate and steady tempo.......................................“Using the metronome on page 34
Practicing using your recorded song ..........................................“Recording Your Performance on page 35
“Turning track playback on and off on page 50
Recording
Recording your performance ...................................................... “Recording Your Performance” on page 35
Saving recorded songs to memory...“Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE]” on page 43
Application Index
10
PF-500
Settings
Making detailed settings for recording and playback
............................................“Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING]” on page 65
Making detailed settings for the metronome
......................................... “Detailed settings for the metronome METRONOME [SETTING]” on page 68
Making detailed settings for the voices
................................................................. “Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]” on page 69
Making detailed settings for MIDI .................................................... “MIDI [MIDI SETTING]” on page 77
Making detailed settings for the PF-500..............................................................“Other settings” on page 81
Connecting the PF-500 to other devices
What is MIDI?......................................................................................................... “About MIDI” on page 77
Recording your performance “AUX OUT [R][L] Pin jacks (LEVEL FIXED), [R][L/L+R] Phone jacks” on
page 52
Raising the volume .. AUX OUT [R][L] Pin jacks (LEVEL FIXED), [R][L/L+R] Phone jacks” on page 52
Outputting other instruments’ sound from the PF-500............... AUX IN [R], [L/L+R] jacks” on page 51
Connecting a computer........................................................ “Connecting a personal computer” on page 53
Assembling the keyboard stand
Using the stand ..................................................................... “Assembling the Keyboard Stand” on page 100
Quick solution
What the PF-500 offers.................................................................................... “Application Index” on page 9
“Features” on page 12
Returning to the main screen.................................................................................“EXIT button on page 18
Resetting the PF-500 to the default setting
................................................................“Restoring the normal (default) settings [FactorySet]” on page 85
Meaning of the messages........................................................................................ “Message List” on page 86
If you have questions about operations and functions
.............................................................................. “Questions about Operations and Functions” on page 90
Troubleshooting............................................................................................... “Troubleshooting” on page 94
Use this index to find reference pages that may be helpful for your application and situation.
PF-500
11
Included Accessories
Pedal Unit
Keyboard Stand
Music Stand
Bench (included or optional depending on locale)
Dust Cover (included or optional depending on locale)
Owner’s Manual
Reference Booklet
12
PF-500
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
SONG KEYBOARD
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
SPLIT CHORUSREVERB
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
VOICE
SETTING
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
SONG
SETTING
FILE
C
A
D
B
UPDOWN
E.BASS XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
VOICE
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
TRACK
1
TOP
SYNCHRO START
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
SONG
MAXMIN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
EXIT
CONTRAST
EFFECT
AUX PEDALAC INLET
AUX IN
R
L/L+R
MIDI
IN THRUOUT
PEDAL TO HOST USB
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
PHONES
ON OFF
POWER
RL R
L/L+R
AUX OUT
LEVEL FIXED
A set of standard
stereo headphones
can be plugged in
here for private prac-
tice. (page 16)
Connect a MIDI device
here to use various MIDI
functions. (page 52, 56)
(About MIDIpage 77)
Connect an optional pedal
here and assign one of
the various functions to
the pedal. (page 52)
This jack and selector switch allow di-
rect connection to a personal computer
for sequencing and other music appli-
cations. (page 5358)
This connector can be
connected to your com-
puter, allowing you to
transfer MIDI data be-
tween the PF-500 and
the computer. (page 52)
These jacks allow you to
connect an external tone
generator to reproduce the
sound via the PF-500s
internal sound system and
speakers. (page 51)
You can output the sound of
the PF-500 from an external
audio system, or connect it to
a cassette tape recorder etc.
and record your playing.
(page 52)
Features
The Yamaha PF-500 electronic piano features rich sounds produced by Yamahas proprietary
“AWM dynamic stereo
sampling”
tone generator system and a
Graded Hammer”
keyboard that varies the key weight according to the key
range, giving these electronic pianos a “playing-feel” that is very close to the keyboard of a genuine grand piano. The
PF-500 GrandPiano1 voice features 3 velocity-switched samples (
Dynamic Sampling
),
String Resonance
(page 83) that recreates resonance of piano strings, special
Sustain Sampling
(page 83)that samples the unique res-
onance of an acoustic grand pianos soundboard and strings when the damper pedal is pressed, and
Key-off Sam-
ples
that add the subtle sound produced when the keys are released. The PF-500 comes much closer to the sound of
a true acoustic piano.
PF-500
13
Features
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
SONG KEYBOARD
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
SPLIT CHORUSREVERB
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
VOICE
SETTING
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
SONG
SETTING
FILE
C
A
D
NO YES
B
UPDOWN
E.BASS XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
VOICE
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
TRACK
1
TOP
SYNCHRO START
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
SONG
MAXMIN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
EXIT
CONTRAST
EFFECT
TEMPO [DOWN] [UP]
You can change the song tempo (speed).
(page 23, 34, 36, 48)
BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] [BRIGHT]
Adjust the brightness of the tone using these
buttons. (page 28)
[VOICE SETTING] / [VARIATION]
You can make detailed settings for
tone and effects. (page 69)
[EXIT]
The screen returns to its
main display when you
press this button. (page 19)
[SONG SETTING]
Make detailed settings for
song recording and playback.
(page 65)
The display
allows accu-
rate control
and operation.
(page 19)
[DEMO]
Demonstration
playback is
available for each
voice. (page 20)
[MASTER VOLUME]
Adjust the volume
level using this dial.
(page 16)
[CONTRAST]
Adjust the bright-
ness of the display
using this control.
(page 16)
[REVERB] / [CHORUS]
Add reverb (reverberation) and spread
(chorus) to the sound. (page 29)
[MIDI SETTING]
Make detailed MIDI settings,
such as MIDI receive/transmit
channels. (page 77)
[FILE]
Save recorded songs and
manage song files. (page 43)
SONG select buttons
This section enables you to
listen to 50 piano preset
songs, as well as to prac-
tice playing the songs using
a convenient Practice func-
tion. You can also record
and play back your perfor-
mance.
(page 22, 35, 48)
[SPLIT]
You can play different
voices on the left- and
right-hand sections of the
keyboard. (page 32)
Voice group buttons
You can choose from sixteen groups of
voices, including grand piano.
You can also combine two sounds and use
them together. (page 26)
[OTHER SETTING]
This lets you make detailed settings, such as adjusting the
keyboard touch or making fine adjustments to the pitch.
(page 81)
[SONG BALANCE]
This lets you adjust the volume
balance between the song playback
and the sound you are playing on
the keyboard. (page 42)
[METRONOME]
Use the metronome
functions. (page 34)
14
PF-500
Before Using the PF-500
About the pedal unit
Insert the plug of the pedal unit, with the
arrow in the plug facing upward.
About the music stand
The PF-500 is supplied with a music stand that
can be attached to the instrument by inserting
it into the holes at the rear of the control panel.
You do not need to install the stand to play the PF-500. However, if you wish to assemble the stand, refer to
page 100.
A
U
X
P
E
D
A
L
A
C
I
N
L
E
T
A
U
X
I
N
R
L
/
L
+
R
M
I
D
I
I
N
T
H
R
U
O
U
T
P
E
D
A
L
T
O
H
O
S
T
U
S
B
H
O
S
T
S
E
L
E
C
T
M
I
D
I
P
C
-
2
U
S
B
M
a
c
P
H
O
N
E
S
O
N
O
F
F
P
O
W
E
R
R
L
R
L
/
L
+
R
A
U
X
O
U
T
L
E
V
E
L
F
I
X
E
D
PF-500 15
Before Using the PF-500
Turning the power on
1. Connect the power cable.
First insert the plug of the power cable into the [AC INLET] on the left side panel, then plug the other end
of the cable into the proper AC outlet on the wall.
WARNING!
Make sure your PF-500 is rated for the AC voltage supplied in the area in which it is to be used (voltage rating appears
on the name plate on the bottom panel). In some areas, a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of the
main keyboard unit. Make sure that the voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. Connecting the unit to the
wrong AC supply can cause serious damage to the internal circuitry and may even pose a shock hazard!
Use only the AC power cord supplied with the PF-500. If the supplied cord is lost or damaged and needs to be replaced,
contact your Yamaha dealer. The use of an inappropriate replacement can pose a re and shock hazard!
The type of AC power cord provided with the PF-500 may be different depending on the country in which it is purchased.
(In some areas a plug adaptor may be provided to match the pin conguration of the AC wall outlets in your area.) Do
NOT modify the plug provided with the PF-500. If the plug will not t the outlet, have a proper outlet installed by a quali-
ed electrician.
2. Turn on the power to the PF-500.
Press the [POWER] switch located on the left side panel to turn on the power.
The screen located in the center of the front panel lights up.
Press the [POWER] switch again to turn off the power to the PF-500.
A
U
X
P
E
D
A
L
A
C
I
N
L
E
T
A
U
X
I
N
R
L
/
L
+
R
M
I
D
I
I
N
T
H
R
U
O
U
T
P
E
D
A
L
T
O
H
O
S
T
U
S
B
H
O
S
T
S
E
L
E
C
T
M
I
D
I
P
C
-
2
U
S
B
M
a
c
P
H
O
N
E
S
O
N
O
F
F
P
O
W
E
R
R
L
R
L
/
L
+
R
A
U
X
O
U
T
L
E
V
E
L
F
I
X
E
D
AC INLET
1
1
0
V
1
3
0
V
2
2
0
V
240V
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
12
(The shape of plug differs
depending on locale.)
A
U
X
P
E
D
A
L
A
C
I
N
L
E
T
A
U
X
I
N
R
L
/
L
+
R
M
I
D
I
I
N
T
H
R
U
O
U
T
P
E
D
A
L
T
O
H
O
S
T
U
S
B
H
O
S
T
S
E
L
E
C
T
M
I
D
I
P
C
-
2
U
S
B
M
a
c
P
H
O
N
E
S
O
N
O
F
F
P
O
W
E
R
R
L
R
L
/
L
+
R
A
U
X
O
U
T
L
E
V
E
L
F
I
X
E
D
ON OFF
POWER
[POWER]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
When you turn on the power to the PF-500, a voice
name appears on the screen.
16 PF-500
Before Using the PF-500
Adjusting the display contrast
You can adjust the contrast of the display by turning the [CONTRAST] knob located to the right of the LCD.
Setting the volume
To adjust the volume, use the [MASTER VOLUME] located at the left of the panel. Play the keyboard to actu-
ally produce sound while you adjust the volume.
Using headphones
Connect a pair of headphones to one of the [PHONES] on the left side panel.
Two [PHONES] jacks are provided. Two sets of standard stereo headphones can be plugged in. (If you are
using only one pair of headphones, you can plug them into either of these jacks.)
CAUTION
Do not use headphones at a high vol-
ume for an extended period of time.
Doing so may cause hearing loss.
C
A
D
B
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
NO YES
Use this knob.
CONTRAST:
difference between
brightness and dark-
ness
TERMINOLOGY
MAXMIN
MASTER VOLUME
CAUTION
Do not use the PF-500 at a
high volume level for a long
period of time, or your
hearing may be damaged.
The level
increases.
The level
decreases.
MASTER VOLUME:
The volume level of the
entire keyboard sound
You can also adjust the
[PHONES] output level, the
AUX IN input level and the
AUX OUT [L/L+R][R] output
level using the [MASTER
VOLUME] dial.
TERMINOLOGY
TIP
A
U
X
P
E
D
A
L
A
C
I
N
L
E
T
A
U
X
I
N
R
L
/
L
+
R
M
I
D
I
I
N
T
H
R
U
O
U
T
P
E
D
A
L
T
O
H
O
S
T
U
S
B
H
O
S
T
S
E
L
E
C
T
M
I
D
I
P
C
-
2
U
S
B
M
a
c
P
H
O
N
E
S
O
N
O
F
F
P
O
W
E
R
R
L
R
L
/
L
+
R
A
U
X
O
U
T
L
E
V
E
L
F
I
X
E
D
PHONES
PF-500 17
Basic Operation
18 PF-500
Part Names
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
SONG KEYBOARD
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
SPLIT CHORUSREVERB
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
VOICE
SETTING
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
SONG
SETTING
FILE
C
A
D
B
UPDOWN
E.BASS XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
VOICE
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
TRACK
1
TOP
SYNCHRO START
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
SONG
MAXMIN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
EXIT
CONTRAST
EFFECT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
SPLIT CHORUSREVERB
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PA D
VIBRA-
PHONE
VOICE
SETTING
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
D
NO YES
B
E.BASS XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
VOICE
EXIT
CONTRAST
EFFECT
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
SONG KEYBOARD
SONG
SETTING
FILE
C
A
UPDOWN
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
TRACK
1
TOP
SYNCHRO START
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
SONG
MAXMIN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
6
2 3
4
5
7
8
9
0
A
B
B
E
F
G H
I J
K
N
L
M
]
1
C
D
C
Center C
C0 D0 E0 F0 G0 A0 B0 C1 D1 E1 F1 G1 A1 B1 C2 D2 E2 F2 G2 A2 B2 C3 D3 E3 F3 G3 A3 B3 C4 D4 E4 F4 G4 A4 B4
C5 D5 E5 F5 G5 A5 B5 C6 D6 E6 F6 G6 A6 B6 C7
B-1A-1
P
O
Q
Top panel
1
[MASTER VOLUME]............................. P16
2 SONG BALANCE.................................. P42
3 [DEMO] ............................................... P20
4 SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] ........P22, 35, 48
5 [TRACK1] [TRACK2] /
[EXTRA TRACKS] ............... P24, 35–40, 50
6 [FILE] ................................................... P43
7 [TOP] / SONG [START/STOP]
................................................ P22, 36, 49
8 [REC] ................................................... P34
9 [SONG SETTING] ................................ P65
0 METRONOME [START/STOP] /
[SETTING] ..................................... P34, 68
A TEMPO [DOWN] [UP] ....... P23, 34, 36, 49
B LCD buttons A [–] [+] / B [– (NO)] [+ (YES)] /
C [–] [+] / D [–] [+] .............................. P19
C LCD screen ..........................................P19
D [CONTRAST] knob ..............................P16
E [EXIT]...................................................P19
F Voice group buttons ...........................P26
G [VOICE SETTING] ................................P69
H [SPLIT] .................................................P32
I [REVERB] .............................................P29
J [CHORUS]............................................P29
K VARIATION [] [].............................P26
L BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] [BRIGHT] ......P28
M [MIDI SETTING] ..................................P77
N [OTHER SETTING] ...............................P81
O Soft pedal............................................P27
P Sostenuto pedal..................................P27
Q Damper pedal .....................................P27
PF-500 19
Part Names
Connectors (Left side panel)
] Panel logos
GM System Level 1
“GM System Level 1” is an addition to the MIDI standard which guarantees that any data conforming to
the standard will play accurately on any GM-compatible tone generator or synthesizer from any manufac-
turer.
XG Format
XG is a new Yamaha MIDI specification which significantly expands and
improves on the “GM System Level 1” standard with greater voice han-
dling capacity, expressive control, and effect capability while retaining full
compatibility with GM.
C LCD
Use the LCD button A, B, C, or D to select the contents dis-
played on the LCD.
Check the screen located in the center of the top panel after
every operation. A voice name appears on the screen when
you turn on the power to the unit.
E [EXIT] button
When you press this button, the unit returns to the default screen (the
screen that indicates a voice name(s) and is displayed when the power is
turned on).
R AUX IN............................................... P51
S AUX OUT ........................................... P52
T [PHONES] .......................................... P16
U [POWER ON/OFF].............................. P15
V [AC INLET] ......................................... P15
W [PEDAL]...................................... P14, 101
X [AUX PEDAL] ...................................... P52
Y MIDI [IN] [OUT] [THRU] .................... P52
Z HOST SELECT ..................................... P52
[ [TO HOST]..........................................P52
\ [USB] .................................................. P52
AUX PEDALAC INLET
AUX IN
R
L/L+R
MIDI
IN THRUOUT
PEDAL TO HOST USB
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
PHONES
ON OFF
POWER
RL R
L/L+R
AUX OUT
LEVEL FIXED
WV X Z [ \
R
S
T U
Y
C
A
D
B
NO YES
20 PF-500
Listening to the Demonstration
Tunes
For each voice group, the PF-500 contains one demo song that shows off the character of the voices.
This section explains how to listen to the demo songs for the voice groups listed below.
Demonstration tunes
The demonstration pieces listed above are short rearranged excerpts the original
compositions.
All other songs are original (©2002 Yamaha Corporation).
Procedure
Mode:
A mode is a status under
which you can execute a
certain function. In demo
mode, you can play back
demonstration tunes.
1. Engage the demo mode.
Press the [DEMO] button to engage the demo mode.
The indicators of the voice group buttons will blink in succession.
Voice group Tunes Composer
HARPSICHORD Gavotte J.S.Bach
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
1 4
2 3
3
4
Voice
group buttons
TERMINOLOGY
PF-500 21
Listening to the Demonstration Tunes
To adjust the volume level of
the demo songs, use the
[MASTER VOLUME] dial.
To adjust the volume bal-
ance between the song
playback and the sound you
are playing on the keyboard,
use the [SONG BALANCE]
slider (page 42) .
2. Select a tune and start playback.
Press the voice group button for the demo song that you
want to hear.
The indicator of the voice group button you pressed will light, and the
demo song will begin playing. Subsequently, the demo songs will play
back consecutively from the upper left voice group button until you
stop the playback.
3. Stop the playback.
Press the button of the voice group being played or the
SONG [START/STOP] button.
4. Exit from demo mode.
Press the [DEMO] or [EXIT] button to exit from demo
mode.
NOTE
TIP
By holding down [DEMO] and pressing A[–][+] to get the [Piano-
Demo] display, you can hear the piano demo. The piano demo lets
you compare the result of enabling/disabling each sampling tech-
nology.
GRAND PIANO1 ................. Stereo Piano (stereo sampling)
GRAND PIANO2 ................. Mono Piano (mono sampling)
E.PIANO1 ............................ mezzo piano (dynamic sampling,
mezzopiano)
E.PIANO2 ............................ mezzo forte (dynamic sampling, mez-
zoforte)
HARPSICHORD .................. forte (dynamic sampling, forte)
E.CLAVICHORD.................. with Sustain (with sustain sampling)
VIBRAPHONE ..................... no Sustain (without sustain sampling)
GUITAR ............................... with KeyOff (with key-off sampling)
CHURCH ORGAN............... no KeyOff (without key-off sampling)
JAZZ ORGAN...................... with StringRes (with string reso-
nance)
STRINGS............................. no StringRes (without string reso-
nance)
22 PF-500
Listening to 50 Piano Preset
Songs
The PF-500 provides performance data of 50 piano songs. You can just listen to these songs (page 22) or use
them for practice (page 24). See page 34 in the Reference Booklet for a complete listening of the preset songs.
Playing the 50 piano preset songs
Procedure
Song:
On the PF-500, perfor-
mance data is called a
Song. This includes dem-
onstration tunes and piano
preset tunes.
1. Select a song.
Press one of the [SONG SELECT] buttons repeatedly to
select the desired piano song from P-001 to P-050.
You can play the keyboard
along with the preset song
playback. You can change the
voice playing on the keyboard.
2. Play a preset song.
Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to start playback.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
1
23 4
METRONOME [START/STOP]
TEMPO [DOWN] [UP]
TERMINOLOGY
Song select screen
C
A
D
B
NO YES
The song number appears on the display.
TIP
You can also use the C
[]/[+] buttons to select a
song after pressing the
[SONG SELECT] button.
[P-000: NewSong] is a
blank song provided for
you to record your perfor-
mance. (See page 35.)
Use the SongRepeat
parameter in the SONG
SETTING menu to
select repeat playback of
all songs or repeat play-
back of a single song.
(See page 67.)
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
the number of measures
PF-500 23
Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs
Adjusting the tempo
You can also use the D[]/[+]
buttons to change the tempo.
Resetting the tempo
Whenever you select a new
preset song, the tempo is
automatically reset to the
songs original value.
You can use the TEMPO [DOWN]/[UP] buttons to adjust the playback
tempo as required. The default tempo (the songs original tempo) is set when
you press the [DOWN] and [UP] buttons simultaneously.
Press either of the SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons to return to the song
select screen.
3. Stop the song playback.
When playback is complete, it automatically stops and the PF-500
locates the top of the song. To stop playback in the middle of a song,
press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by pressing the
SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you press the
button.
Fast forward and rewind
You can perform the following operations in the song select screen:
Use the B [–]/[+] buttons to move back and forth (rewind and fast for-
ward) through the song while the song is played or stopped.
Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C [–] button during playback to
restart playback from the top of the song.
Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C [+] button during playback to
start playback from the next song.
Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C [–] button while playback is
stopped in the middle of the song to locate the top of the song.
Default screen:
The default screen is a voice
select screen (page 26) that
appears when you turn on
the power to the PF-500.
4. Return to the default screen.
Press the [EXIT] button.
TIP
NOTE
C
A
D
B
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TERMINOLOGY
24 PF-500
Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs
Practicing a one-hand part using 50 preset songs
The 50 preset songs have separate left- and right-hand parts on individual tracks. You can turn the left- and
right-hand parts on or off as required so you can practice the corresponding part (the part that is turned off)
on the keyboard. The right-hand part is played by [TRACK 1] and the left-hand part is played by [TRACK 2].
procedure
You can turn parts on or off,
even during playback.
1. Turn off the playback part you wish to practice.
After you select a song to practice, press the [TRACK1] or
[TRACK2] button to turn off the corresponding part.
When you first select a song, both [TRACK1] and [TRACK2] indica-
tors light up, indicating that you can play back both parts. When you
press one of the buttons to turn off playback, the corresponding but-
ton indicator turns off and the corresponding part playback is muted.
Pressing the buttons repeatedly toggles between playback on and off.
2. Start playback and playing.
Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to start playback.
Play the part you just turned off.
Synchro:
Synchronous;occurring at the
same time
Starting playback automatically as you start playing the
keyboard (Synchro Start)
You can cause playback to begin when you play the keyboard (Syn-
chro Start).
Hold down [TOP] and press SONG [START/STOP]. The SONG
[START/STOP] indicator will blink, and the PF-500 will wait for Syn-
cro Start.
Now when you play the keyboard, playback will begin at the same
moment.
If you press [TOP] while waiting, Synchro Start will be cancelled.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
1
23
TIP
TERMINOLOGY
PF-500 25
Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs
3. Stop playback.
Resetting the part play-
back
Both parts are automatically
turned ON whenever you
select a new song.
When playback is complete, it automatically stops and the PF-500
locates the top of the song. If you wish to stop playback in the middle
of a song, press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by
pressing the SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you
press the button.
TIP
You can also assign a phrase in a song to repeatedly practice that part. Refer to
the [FromToRepeat] option in the “SONG SETTING” menu on page 66.
26 PF-500
Selecting and Playing Voices
Selecting Voices
Procedure
Voice
On the PF-500, a voice
means tone or tonal color.
You can also switch between
voices in the same group by
pressing a voice group but-
ton repeatedly.
To learn characteristics of
the voices, listen to demo
songs for each voice group
(page 20). Refer to Preset
Voice List on page 97 for
more information on charac-
teristics of each preset voice.
You can control the loudness of
a voice by how hard you play
the keyboard, although differ-
ent playing styles (touch sensi-
tivities) have little or no effect
with the sound of certain musi-
cal instruments. Refer to Pre-
set Voice List on page 97.
XG is a major enhancement
of the GM System level 1
format, and was developed
by Yamaha specially to pro-
vide more voices and varia-
tions, as well as greater
expressive control over
voices and effects, and to
ensure compatibility of data
well into the future.
If you select XG and then
simultaneously press the
VARIATION [
][] buttons,
the XG voice select screen
will appear.
1. Select a voice group.
Press a voice group button.
2. Select a voice.
Use VARIATION [
][] or A [–][+] to select a voice.
If you select XG
If you select XG, you can select the XG voice group first, then select the
desired voice.
2-1. Simultaneously press the [–][+] screen buttons located
beside the XG voice name display, to access a screen
where you can select XG voices.
2-2. Use A [–][+] to select the voice group.
2-3. Use C [–][+] to select the desired voice.
For details on XG voices, refer to XG voice list (the separate data list booklet).
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
2
1
2
Voice
group buttons
TERMINOLOGY
TIP
TIP
TIP
TIP
TIP
Voice group Voice name Voice group Voice name
GRANDPIANO1
GrandPiano1
CHURCHORGAN
PipeOrganPrincipal
MellowPiano PipeOrganTutti
RockPiano PipeOrganFlute1
HonkyTonkPiano PipeOrganFlute2
GRANDPIANO2
GrandPiano2
JAZZORGAN
JazzOrgan
BrightPiano RotaryOrgan
E.PIANO1
E.Piano1 MellowOrgan
SynthPiano
STRINGS
Strings
E.PIANO2
E.Piano2 SynthStrings
Vintage E.Piano SlowStrings
HARPSICHORD
Harpsichord8'
CHOIR
Choir
Harpsichord8'+4' SlowChoir
E.CLAVICHORD
E.Clavichord Scat
Wah Clavi.
SYNTH.PAD
SynthPad1
VIBRAPHONE
Vibraphone SynthPad2
Marimba
WOOD BASS
WoodBass
Celesta Bass&Cymbal
GUITAR
NylonGuitar
E.BASS
ElectricBass
SteelGuitar FretlessBass
XG XGVoice
PF-500 27
Selecting and Playing Voices
Using the pedals
The PF-500 has three foot pedals: damper pedal (right), sostenuto pedal
(center), and soft pedal (left) that produce a range of expressive effects
similar to those produced by the pedals on an acoustic piano.
If the damper pedal doesnt
work, or notes are sustained
even when the pedal is not
pressed, make sure that the
pedal cord is properly
plugged into the PEDAL jack
on the unit (see page 14).
Also, make sure that the
RPedal parameter in the
VOICE SETTING menu is
set to ON (see page 75).
Damper (right) pedal
When you press the damper pedal, the notes
you play have a longer sustain.
When you select Grand Piano 1, pressing the
damper pedal activates the instruments special
“Sustain Samples to accurately recreate the
unique resonance of an acoustic grand pianos
soundboard and strings.
You can adjust the depth of
the resonance produced by
the Sustain Samples using
the Sustain Sampling Depth
parameter in the OTHER
SETTING menu. (See
page 83.)
Sostenuto (center) pedal
If you play a note or chord on the keyboard
and press the sostenuto pedal while holding
the note(s), the notes will sustain as long as
the pedal is held. All subsequent notes will
not sustain.
You can assign a function to
each pedal via the R
Pedal, M Pedal, and L
Pedal parameters in the
VOICE SETTING menu.
(See pages 75, 76.)
The center and left pedals
can also be assigned to
song start/stop operation
(START/STOP function) via
the PedalStart/Stop
parameter in the OTHER
SETTING menu (on
page 84).
Soft pedal (left)
The soft pedal reduces the volume and slightly changes the timbre of notes
played while the pedal is pressed. (The soft pedal will not affect notes that are
already playing when it is pressed. Press the pedal immediately before you
play the target notes.)
With the Vibraphone and Jazz Organ voices, this pedal turns vibrato on and
off or toggles the speed of vibrato. (See page 83.)
TIP
When you press the damper
pedal here, the notes you
play before you release the
pedal have a longer sustain.
TIP
When you press the sostenuto
pedal here while holding the
note(s), the notes will sustain
as long as you hold the pedal.
TIP
TIP
28 PF-500
Selecting and Playing Voices
Adding variation to the sound
[BRILLIANCE]/[REVERB]/[CHORUS]
The Effect function enables you to add expression to the sound. The PF-500 effects include Brilliance,
Reverb, and Chorus.
[BRILLIANCE]
You can use this control to adjust the brilliance of the tone and change the tonality to suit your preference.
Procedure
You can press BRILLIANCE
[MELLOW] [BRIGHT], and
then use D [][+] to select
the desired tonality.
Normal setting = Normal
Normal setting:
The Normal setting refers
to the default setting (factory
setting) obtained when you
rst turn on the power to the
PF-500.
If you select [Bright1],
[Bright2] or [Bright3] as the
type of brilliance, the volume
level will increase slightly.
Under this condition, if you
raise the [MASTER VOL-
UME] dial setting, the sound
may become distorted. In
this case, lower the volume
accordingly.
Press one of the BRILLIANCE [MELLOW]/ [BRIGHT] buttons
to select the desired tonality.
Normal........... Standard tone
Press the [EXIT] button to return to the main screen.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
[REVERB]
BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] / [BRIGHT]
[CHORUS]
TIP
TIP
TERMINOLOGY
NOTE
Mellow3
Soft and mellow tone.
The sound becomes more mellow and rounder as the
number increases.
Mellow2
Mellow1
Bright1
Bright tone.
The sound becomes brighter as the number increases.
Bright2
Bright3
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 29
Selecting and Playing Voices
[REVERB]
This control adds reverberation to the sound by simulating the natural reverberation of a concert hall.
Procedure
You can select a reverb type
via the Reverb Type param-
eter in the VOICE SET-
TING menu, and adjust the
reverb depth for the selected
voice via the Reverb Send
parameter. (See page 71.)
Normal setting = ON
Pressing the [REVERB] button repeatedly toggles the reverb
on and off.
Even if the reverb effect is turned off, a “soundboard reverb effect
will be applied when the GrandPiano1 or GrandPiano2 voice is
selected.
[CHORUS]
This control adds spread and spaciousness to the sound.
Procedure
You can select a chorus type
via the Chorus Type param-
eter in the VOICE SET-
TING menu, and adjust the
chorus depth for the
selected voice via the
Reverb Send parameter. You
can also turn chorus on or
off via the Chorus On Off
parameter. (See page 71.)
Normal Setting
The normal chorus on/off
setting is different for each
voice.
Pressing the [CHORUS] button repeatedly toggles the cho-
rus on and off.
You can turn the chorus effect on and off by pressing the [CHORUS]
ON/OFF buttons on the panel and by setting the Chorus On Off
parameter in the VOICE SETTING menu (see page 72). The [CHO-
RUS] ON/OFF button setting on the panel is temporary. That is, if
you select another voice, the chorus setting for the previous voice is
cancelled. The Chorus On Off parameter setting is saved for each
voice. That is, if you select a given voice, the chorus setting is auto-
matically turned on or off according to the saved chorus setting.
TIP
TIP
TIP
TIP
30 PF-500
Selecting and Playing Voices
Combining two voices (Dual mode)
You can play two voices simultaneously across the entire range of the keyboard. In this way, you can simulate
a melody duet or combine two similar voices to create a thicker sound. Refer to “Voice Combination Exam-
ples (Dual and Split)” on page 99 for examples of effective voice combinations.
Dual mode using voices in different voice groups
Procedure
1. Enter Dual mode.
If you want to select Dual
mode for the left-hand area
when the entire keyboard is
divided into left and right
areas (page 32), hold down
[SPLIT] and simultaneously
press two voice group but-
tons.
You can also use the VARIA-
TION []/[] buttons to
select the voice 1.
Refer to page 26 for details
on how to select XG voices.
Press two voice group buttons simultaneously.
2. Select a voice.
Use the A [–]/[+] buttons and B [–]/[+] buttons to select a
voice.
The voices listed in the upper row in “Preset Voice List on page 97 are
called voice 1, and those listed in the bottom row are called voice 2.
3. Exit Dual mode and return to normal play mode.
Press any voice group button.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
2
1 3
1 43
2
2
Voice
The numbers on the upper row indicate the steps
The numbers on the bottom row indicate the steps
group buttons
in Dual mode using voices from different groups.
in Dual mode using voices from the same group.
Voice
group buttons
TIP
TIP
TIP
C
A
D
B
Voice 1 Voice 2
NO YES
PF-500 31
Selecting and Playing Voices
Dual mode using voices in the same voice group
Procedure
If you want to select Dual
mode for the left-hand area
when the entire keyboard is
devided into left and right
areas (page 32), press D []
[+].
1. Select a voice group.
In normal play mode, press the desired voice group but-
ton.
2. Select a voice.
Use the A [–]/[+] buttons to select a voice.
3. Select another voice.
Use the B [–]/[+] buttons to select another voice in the
same voice group.
To use the identical voices, press the B [–]/[+] buttons once. To use
different voices within the same voice group, press the B [–]/[+] but-
tons repeatedly.
4. Exit Dual mode and return to normal play mode.
Press any voice group button.
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
32 PF-500
Selecting and Playing Voices
Splitting the keyboard range and playing two differ-
ent voices (Split mode)
Split mode enables you to play two different voices on the keyboard — one with the left hand and another
with the right hand. For example, you can play a bass part using the [WOOD BASS] or [E. BASS] voice with
the left hand, and a melody with the right hand. Refer to “Voice Combination Examples (Dual and Split)” on
page 99 for examples of effective voice combinations.
Procedure
1. Enter Split mode.
Press [SPLIT].
You can also use A [][+] to
select a voice for the right-
hand area.
Refer to page 26 for details
on how to select XG voice.
2. Select a voice for the right hand.
Use the voice group buttons and VARIATION [
][] to
select the voice for the right-hand area.
3. Select a voice for the left hand.
Hold down [SPLIT], and press a voice group button to
select the voice group for the left-hand area.
Use C [–][+] to select a voice.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
2 3 1 3 4 5
4 23
Voice
group buttons
TIP
TIP
PF-500 33
Selecting and Playing Voices
A specied split point key
is included in the left-hand
range.
The split point can also be
set by the [OTHER SET-
TING] parameter [Split-
Point]. (page 69)
4. Specify the split point (the border between the right-
and left-hand range).
The normal setting of the split point is “F
2.
To change the split point setting:
Hold down [SPLIT], then use the D [–]/[+] to specify the
split point.
(Optional) Press and hold down the [SPLIT] and play the
key you wish to assign as the split point.
Release the [SPLIT] button to return to the main screen.
5. Exit Split mode and return to normal play mode.
Press [SPLIT].
TIP
TIP
You can use Dual (see page 30) in each area (right-hand and left-hand) of Split
mode.
F
2
Center C
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
34 PF-500
Selecting and Playing Voices
Using the metronome
The PF-500 is built-in metronome (a device that keeps an accurate tempo) is a convenient feature for prac-
tice.
Procedure
1. Start the metronome.
Press the METRONOME [START/STOP] button.
When the metronome is sounding, the beat indicator flashes at the
current tempo.
Adjusting the tempo
The default tempo is 120. (If
a song has been selected,
the song tempo is used.)
Press the TEMPO [DOWN] or [UP] button.
You can set the time signa-
ture, metronome volume,
and metronome tone using
the METRONOME [SET-
TING] button. (See page 68.)
To adjust the tempo (number of beats per minute: 10–500), use the TEMPO
[DOWN]/[UP] or the D [–]/[+] buttons. To reset the tempo to the normal
(default) setting, press the [DOWN] and [UP] keys or the D [–] and [+] keys
simultaneously.
Press the [EXIT] button to return to the normal screen.
2. Stop the metronome.
Press the METRONOME [START/STOP] button.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
1 2
TEMPO [DOWN] [UP]
TIP
C
A
D
B
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TIP
PF-500 35
Recording Your Performance
You can record your perfor-
mance (audio data) to a cas-
sette tape recorder or other
recording devices via the
AUX OUT connector. (see
page 52.)
This chapter explains how to record your performance using the PF-500
recording function.
You can, for example, play back what you have played on the PF-500 keyboard
for an effective practice aid. You can also record just the left-hand part, then
practice the right-hand part while playing back the recorded left-hand part.
Since you can record up to sixteen tracks separately, you could record the left-
and right-hand parts separately, or record each part of a four-handed perfor-
mance or ensemble song one by one to build a song.
Recording vs. Saving:
The format of performance data recorded on a cassette tape differs from that of data recorded on the PF-500. A cassette
tape records audio signals. On the other hand, the PF-500 saves information regarding note timing, voices, and a
tempo value, but not audio signals. When you play back recorded songs, the PF-500 produces sound based on the
saved information. Therefore, recording on the PF-500 may be more accurately called saving information. However, this
book often uses the word recording because it seems to make more sense.
A message (information or confirmation dialog) sometimes appears on the screen to facilitate operation.
Refer to the “Message List” on page 86 for an explanation of each message, appropriate actions to take, and
troubleshooting information.
Recording a New Song
Recording to [TRACK 1]
Procedure
If you select a song other
than P-000: NewSong and
record on a track that already
has data, the existing data on
the track will be lost.
1. Select “NewSong” for recording.
Press the SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons simultaneously.
TIP
TERMINOLOGY
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
2
4 54
1 3
NOTE
New Song screen
C
A
D
B
NO YES
36 PF-500
Recording Your Performance
Set the tempo in Step 3.
See page 42 for more infor-
mation on recording in Dual/
Split mode.
2. Select a voice.
Select a voice (or voices) for recording (see page 26).
Set the other parameters, such as reverb and chorus.
Adjust the [MASTER VOLUME] dial to set the volume level to suit
your preference. You can also use the dial to adjust the level during
playback.
After you set the tempo or if the record standby screen does not
appear, press one of the SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons once to
return to the New Song screen.
3. Enter record mode and select a recording track.
Press and hold down the [REC] button and press the
[TRACK 1] button.
The [TRACK 1] indicator flashes in red. (To cancel recording, press
the [REC] or [TOP] button.)
Set the tempo, if necessary.
If this record standby screen does not appear, press one of the SONG
SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons once.
You can record data while
using the metronome. The
metronome is not recorded.
When you press the SONG
[START/STOP] button dur-
ing recording, recording is
paused. To resume record-
ing, press the SONG
[START/STOP] button again
or play a note on the key-
board.
4. Start and stop recording.
Recording begins automatically as soon as you play a
note on the keyboard.
(Optional) Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to start recording.
The recording screen displays the current measure number.
When you press the [REC]
button, recording pauses.
To stop recording, press the [TOP] button. The PF-500
locates the top of the song.
The [TRACK 1] indicator lights up in green. (Record mode is auto-
matically cancelled.)
NOTE
NOTE
Record standby screen
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TIP
TIP
Record screen
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Measure number in recording
TIP
PF-500 37
Recording Your Performance
To erase recorded data from
a track, use the Channel
Clear parameter in the
SONG SETTING menu.
(See page 66.)
5. Play back the recorded performance.
Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to play back the
recorded performance.
When playback is complete, it automatically stops and the PF-500
locates the top of the song. To stop playback in the middle of a song,
press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by pressing the
SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you press the
button.
Re-recording TRACK 1
This section explains how to record again in case your performance was not satisfactory.
Procedure
1. Select a voice or voices for recording, if necessary.
Repeat Step 2 on page 36 if you wish to change the previ-
ous settings.
Follow the procedure from Step 3 on page 36 to re-record.
The original performance data will be overwritten by new performance data.
NOTE
When you turn off the power to the PF-500, the recorded performance
data will be lost. If you wish to keep the recording, save the data using the
SaveToMemory parameter (page 45) in the File menu.
38 PF-500
Recording Your Performance
Re-recording TRACK 1 partially
This section explains how to record part of a song again.
Procedure
If the playback screen is not
displayed, press one of the
SONG SELECT [ ] [ ]
buttons once.
1. Pause the song at the beginning of the part you wish
to re-record.
Use the B [–]/[+] buttons while the playback screen is dis-
played to move through the measures or play back the
recording and press the SONG [START/STOP] button to
locate a point slightly prior to the beginning of the part
you wish to re-record.
2. Select a voice or voices for recording, if necessary.
Repeat Step 2 on page 36 if you wish to change the previ-
ous settings.
3. Select the recording method and enter record mode.
3-1 Press and hold down the [REC] button, and press the
C [–]/[+] buttons repeatedly to specify how the
recording should start and press the D [–]/[+] buttons
repeatedly to specify how the recording should end.
When the starting method is
set to KeyOn, you cannot
change a voice or tempo
(page 41) after the recording
is complete.
While you are holding down the [REC] button, the following record-
ing method select screen appears.
Starting methods:
Norm (Normal) — The existing data will be erased after re-recording
starts.
Key On — Data that exists prior to the point where you start playing a
note will not be erased.
NOTE
Playback screen
C
A
D
B
NO YES
NOTE
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 39
Recording Your Performance
Ending methods:
Replace – The data after the point you stop recording will also be
erased.
Punch Out — The data after the point you stop recording will remain.
If you cancel recording by
pressing the [REC] button,
recording stops when you
press the button. If you can-
cel recording by pressing
the [TOP] button, the PF-
500 locates the top of the
song.
3-2 Keep holding down the [REC] button and press the
[TRACK 1] button.
The [TRACK 1] indicator flashes in red.
(To stop recording, press the [REC] button again or press the [TOP]
button.)
Follow the procedure beginning with Step 4 on page 36.
Recording to [TRACK2]
This section explains how to record another part on the second track.
Procedure
1. Select a voice.
Select a voice (or voices) for recording.
Repeat Step 2 on page 36.
Pressing the [TRACK 1] but-
ton repeatedly toggles
between playback on (the
indicator lights up in green)
and off (the indicator turns
off).
2. Enter record mode and select a recording track.
Press and hold down the [REC] button and press the
[TRACK 2] button.
The [TRACK 2] indicator flashes in red. (To cancel recording, press
the [REC] or [TOP] button.)
Make the recording by following the procedure beginning with Step 4 on page 36.
You can record a new part while listening to playback of the recorded [TRACK 1] data.
TIP
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
1
2
TIP
40 PF-500
Recording Your Performance
Recording to the third or more tracks [EXTRA TRACKS]
You can continue recording other parts into tracks 3–16 [EXTRA TRACKS] one by one.
Procedure
1. Hold down the [REC] button in step 2 in the “Record-
ing to [TRACK2]” on page 39 and use the B [–]/[+] but-
tons to select a recording track (3–16).
2. While holding down the [REC] key, press the [EXTRA
TRACKS] button.
Then, follow the procedure beginning with Step 4 on page 36.
Other recording techniques
Adding data to or recording over an existing song
The previous section explains how to record your performance from the beginning by selecting a blank “P-
000: NewSong. You can also add your performance to or overwrite existing songs (such as 50 preset piano
songs [P-001—P-050], or your old recorded performances [see page 43]).
Procedure
If you record on a track that
already has data, the exist-
ing data on the track will be
lost.
1. Select a song for recording (P-001 – P-050).
Select one of the preset songs (P-001–P-050) instead of “P-000:
NewSong” as described in Step 1 of “Recording to [TRACK1]” on
page 35. To select a song from already-recorded data, see Steps 1 and 2
on page 48.
To continue recording, follow the procedure described in “Recording a New Song” from page 35 to 40.
C
A
D
B
NO YES
select a recording track (3-16)
NOTE
PF-500 41
Recording Your Performance
Changing a voice or tempo after recording
You can change the voice and tempo after recording to change a songs feel or to set a more suitable tempo.
You can also change these elements in the middle of a song.
Procedure
When the starting method is
set to KeyOn, you cannot
change a voice or tempo
(page 38) after the recording
is complete.
Refer to Questions about
Operations and Functions
on page 90 for information
on the settings that can be
changed here.
Change the tempo in Step 4.
The edited settings (except
for the tempo setting) will be
saved in memory and you
will not be able to restore the
previous settings. Proceed
with caution.
1. Select a song you wish to change by using the SONG
SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons.
2. To change the voice or tempo in the middle of the
song, specify the measure to change using the B [–]/
[+] buttons.
3. Change the settings (voice, reverb, etc.).
For example, if you wish to change the recorded E.Piano1 voice to E.
Piano2, use the voice group buttons and the A [–]/[+] buttons to
select E.Piano2.
When the setting is complete, press one of the SONG SELECT [ ]
[ ] buttons once to return to the song select screen.
4. Press and hold down the [REC] button and select the
track to change.
The indicator for the selected track lights up in red.
Change the tempo setting now, if necessary.
At this point, do not play the keyboard or press the SONG [START/
STOP] button. Otherwise, recording will start, erasing the recorded
data.
5. Press the [TOP] or [REC] button to exit record mode.
NOTE
TIP
TIP
CAUTION
42 PF-500
Recording Your Performance
Adjusting the volume balance between playback and your performance [SONG
BALANCE]
While recording multiple parts into tracks one by one, you can adjust the volume balance between the play-
back of the recorded parts and your current performance.
Procedure
The song balance setting is
also used during playback.
(See page 48.)
1. Move [SONG BALANCE] to the left or right to make
adjustments.
Recording in Dual or Split mode
When you record in Dual or Split mode, the PF-500 records each voice onto a separate track. The following
table shows how tracks are assigned to each voice.
CAUTION
When you record multiple parts into tracks one by one, or when you record new data over an existing song (see
page 40), the existing data will be erased. Proceed with caution.
In the following example, Tracks 1, 2, and EXTRA TRACKn have been selected for recording.
Note: TRACKn = TRACK 3 TRACK 16
If n+1, n+2, and n+3 exceed 16, TRACKs 1, 2, and 3 are used.
Switching between Dual and Split mode in a song is not recorded.
TIP
SONG BALANCE
SONG KEYBOARD
The song playback vol-
ume will be lower.
Your playing volume
will be lower.
Tracks assigned for
recording
Dual Split Split+Dual
TRACK1 TRACK2
EXTRA
TRACKn
TRACK1 TRACK2
EXTRA
TRACKn
TRACK1 TRACK2
EXTRA
TRACKn
↓↓↓ ↓↓↓ ↓↓↓
Tracks
used for
record-
ing
MAIN
(voice 1)
TRACK1 TRACK2 TRACKn TRACK1 TRACKn TRACK1 TRACKn
LEFT
(voice 1)
TRACK2 TRACKn+1 TRACK2 TRACKn +1
MAIN
(voice 2)
TRACK3 TRACK4
TRACKn
+2
TRACK3 TRACKn +2
LEFT
(voice 2)
––
TRACK4 TRACKn +3
TIP
PF-500 43
Saving Recorded Songs and
Handling the Files...[FILE]
File
A le contains a group of
data. On the PF-500, a song
le includes song data and a
song number.
Memory
Memory is a location inside
the PF-500 in which you can
save and edit data.
Character code
Type of characters
File screens (accessed via the [FILE] button) enables you to handle song files
(e.g., save, delete, and rename recorded songs), and change the characters on
the screen.
The following parameters are provided for these operations:
PF-500 memory
The PF-500 has the following three types of memory:
Current memory:
This is a temporary memory area where you can temporarily place and edit
the currently-selected song before playback or recording.
Preset song memory:
This read-only memory area saves 50 piano preset songs.
Storage memory:
This memory area enables you to save recorded songs.
When you select a song in the song select screen, it is loaded from Preset song
memory or Storage memory into Current memory.
You will use Current memory to play back and record songs. When you turn
off the power to the PF-500, songs saved in Preset song memory and Storage
memory are not erased. On the other hand, songs in Current memory are
lost. If you wish to keep a song in Current memory, you must save it in Stor-
age memory (see pages 45).
In this manual, a song located in a song recorded in Current memory, is
referred to as a Current song and a song in Storage memory is a Memory
song.”
TERMINOLOGY
Settings Parameter name
Reference
page
Saves recorded and other songs in PF-500
memory
SaveToMemory 45
Deletes a song from PF-500 memory DeleteSong 46
Changes the title of songs RenameSongs 47
Change the type of characters on the screen CharacterCode 47
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
SONG KEYBOARD
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
SPLIT CHORUSREVERB
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
VOICE
SETTING
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
SONG
SETTING
FILE
C
A
D
B
UPDOWN
E.BASS XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
VOICE
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
TRACK
1
TOP
SYNCHRO START
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
SONG
MAXMIN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
EXIT
CONTRAST
EFFECT
PF-500
Preset song
memory
Storage memory
Current memory
44 PF-500
Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE]
Basic file operation
A message (information or confirmation dialog) sometimes appears on the screen to facilitate operation.
Refer to the “Message List” on page 86 for an explanation of each message, appropriate actions to take.
Procedure
1. Select a song.
Select a song you wish to save or rename.
2. Access the File menu.
Press the [FILE] button.
To close the File menu, press the [EXIT] button once or twice.
3. Select the desired parameter.
Press the [FILE] or A [–]/[+] buttons repeatedly to display the desired
item from the following:
“SaveToMemory”, “DeleteSong, “RenameSong”, “CharacterCode.
4. Set the parameter or execute the command.
Use the B [– (NO)]/[+ (YES)], C [–]/[+], D [–]/[+] buttons.
For more information regarding this procedure, refer to the corre-
sponding section below.
5. Close the File menu.
Press the [EXIT] button.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
54
2 3 3
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 45
Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE]
Saving recorded or other songs to PF-500 Storage
memory...[SaveToMemory]
If you record a song, then turn off the power to the PF-500, the song will be erased. To save the recorded
song, you must save it into the PF-500 Storage memory. You can also save the preset songs, and additional or
overwriting recordings (page 40) to Storage memory.
Procedure
See page 44 the basic operation information. The following is a detailed pro-
cedure of Step 4.
4-1 Name the song.
To move the cursor (a small underline), use the C [–]/[+] buttons.
To insert a space, press the C [–]/[+] buttons simultaneously.
To select a character on the cursor, use the D [–]/[+] buttons.
To delete a character, press the D [–]/[+] buttons simultaneously.
You can use up to 58 characters for a song name. If the name is longer
than the screen, use the C [–]/[+] buttons to move the cursor and
scroll the name.
Execute?: Do you wish
to execute the operation?
Sure?: Are you sure?
Executing: The PF-500 is
executing the operation.
Completed: The operation
is complete.
4-2 Execute the operation.
Press the B [+ (YES)] button located next to “Execute?”.
“Sure?
appears on the screen. Press the B [+ (YES)] button again
to confirm the operation. (To cancel the operation, press the B [–
(NO)] button.)
The PF-500 displays “Executing” on the screen during the operation.
When the operation is complete, “Completed” appears.
The song is automatically numbered as “M—, where “M” means
“Memory” and “—” is a number.
Do not turn off the power
while the screen displays
Executing.
If Storage memory contains one or more songs, and you save a new song, the PF-500
automatically sorts the songs alphabetically and renumbers them.
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TIP
You can change the type
of characters on the
screen using the Char-
acterCode parameter.
When you select a saved
song later, the name with
an extension .MID will
appear.
TERMINOLOGY
CAUTION
TIP
46 PF-500
Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE]
Deleting a Memory song...[DeleteSong]
To delete a Current song,
select ALL for the Channel-
Clear parameter in the
SONG SETTING menu
(page 66). Alternatively,
press the SONG SELECT
[ ]/[ ] buttons simulta-
neously to display Song
Changed Save?. This
means A song has been
edited. Do you wish to save
the change? Press the B [
(NO)] button. The Current
song is deleted and a blank
NewSong is selected.
This deletes a song from memory. You cannot delete a preset song or the cur-
rent song.
Procedure
Deleting a Memory song
does not erase song data
from Current memory. How-
ever, if you return to the
song select screen, song
information other than the
song name is replaced by
--------------.
After you delete a song, the
PF-500 automatically
updates the song numbers.
Never turn off the power
while [Executing] is dis-
played.
See page 44 for basic operation information. The following is a detailed pro-
cedure of Step 4.
4-1 Select a song to delete.
Use the C [–]/[+] buttons to select a song.
4-2 Execute the operation.
Press the B [+ (YES)] button located next to “Execute?.”
Follow the instructions on screen.
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TIP
TIP
CAUTION
PF-500 47
Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE]
Renaming a song...[RenameSong]
You can change a songs title except for the preset songs and [P-000: NewSong].
Procedure
Do not turn off the power
while the screen displays
Executing.
After you rename a song,
the PF-500 sorts songs
alphabetically and renum-
bers them.
See page 44 for basic operation information. The following is a detailed pro-
cedure for Step 4.
4. Name the song as described in the [SaveToMemory]
section (page 45).
Changing the type of characters on screen...[Char-
acterCode]
You can change the type of characters that appear on screen.
The default setting is “International. To input katakana, change this setting to “Japanese.
Options: International, Japanese
Character list
[International]
[Japanese]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
CAUTION
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
48 PF-500
Playing Back Recorded Songs
Change the PF-500s char-
acter type ([Character-
Cord]) as appropriate for the
selected song.
You can play back songs recorded using the Record function (page 35). You
can also play the keyboard along with the playback.
Songs containing a large amount of data may not be able to be read properly by the
instrument, and as such you may not be able to select them. The maximum capacity is
about 200300KB, however this may differ depending on the data contents of each
song.
Playing back a song
Procedure
You can enjoy ensemble
performance by yourself.
Record the parts for a four-
handed song or a piano
duet, then play the recorded
part while playing the other
part on the keyboard.
Use the SongRepeat
parameter in the SONG
SETTING menu (page 67)
to select repeat playback of
all songs or repeat playback
of a single song.
If the song name extends
beyond what can be dis-
played in the screen, you
can press D [+] to move
toward the right in steps of
one character. Press D [] to
move back to the left in
steps of one character.
1. Display the song select screen.
Press either the SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons.
2. Select the desired song.
2-1 Use the A [–]/[+] buttons to select the song type: “Pre-
setSong” or “MemorySong.”
If the internal Storage memory contains one or more songs, the PF-
500 displays “MemorySong.
2-2 Use the C [–]/[+] or SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons
to select a song.
TIP
TIP
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
1 2-2
32-2 54
2-1
[SONG BALANCE]
TEMPO [DOWN] [UP]
TIP
TIP
TIP
Song select screen
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 49
Playing Back Recorded Songs
3. Start playback.
Press the SONG [START/STOP] button.
Starting playback automatically as you start playing the keyboard (Syn-
chro Start)
You can start playback as soon as you start playing the keyboard. This is called
the “Synchro Start” function.
To enter Synchro Start standby mode, press and hold down the [TOP] button
and press the SONG [START/STOP] button. The SONG [START/STOP]
indicator flashes.
Now play the keyboard. Playback starts simultaneously.
To cancel the Synchro Start function, press the [TOP] button while the PF-
500 is in Synchro Start standby mode.
Bar: measure
You can play the metronome
along with the song play-
back. When you stop play-
back, the metronome is also
stopped.
In the song select screen:
You can move back and forth (rewind and fast forward) through the bars by
using the B [–]/[+] buttons in the song select screen while the PF-500 is play-
ing or stopped.
You can play the keyboard while the PF-500 is playing back a song. You can
also play the notes in a voice different from the playback voice by selecting the
voice from the panel, and adjusting the volume balance between the playback
parts and your current performance using the [SONG BALANCE] slider. (See
page 42.)
Press either of the SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons to return to the song
select screen.
Adjusting the tempo
You can use the TEMPO [DOWN]/[UP] buttons to adjust the playback
tempo as required before or during playback. The default tempo (the song’s
original tempo) is set when you press the [DOWN] and [UP] buttons simul-
taneously.
Press either of the SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons to return to the song
select screen.
4. Stop playback.
When playback is complete, the PF-500 automatically stops and
locates the top of the song. To stop playback in the middle of a song,
press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by pressing the
SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you press the
button.
5. Return to the main screen.
Press the [EXIT] button.
TERMINOLOGY
TIP
TIP
Press the SONG
SELECT [ ] or the C[
] button while playback is
stopped in the middle of
the song to locate the
top of the song.
Press the SONG
SELECT [ ] or the C[
] button during playback
to restart playback from
the top of the song.
Press the SONG
SELECT [ ] or the
C[+] button during play-
back to start playback
from the next song.
C
A
D
B
NO YES
The bar number in playback
50 PF-500
Playing Back Recorded Songs
Turning track playback on and off
You can practice a part or
phrase using the FromToRe-
peat (page 66) and Phrase-
Mark parameters (page 67)
in the SONG SETTING
menu.
When you select a song on the PF-500, the indicators for tracks that contain
data ([TRACK 1], [TRACK 2], [EXTRA TRACKS]) are lit in green. While the
PF-500 is playing or stopped, pressing these track buttons turn off the indica-
tors, and the data on those tracks will not be played. Pressing the track but-
tons toggles track playback on and off. You can play the part that is turned off.
Supported song data type
Data formats that can be played on the PF-500
The PF-500 plays song data in the following formats:
Sequence format:
A structured method for
recording performance data.
Sequence format
SMF (Standard MIDI File) formats 0 and 1
ESEQ
Voice arrangement format:
A structured method for
numbering the voices for
assignment.
Voice arrangement format
XG voice arrangement
GM system level 1 voice arrangement
DOC voice arrangement
See page 6 of the separate “Reference Booklet for the XG voice list.
Refer to “Data compatibility” on page 95 for more information on
formats.
TIP
TERMINOLOGY
TERMINOLOGY
PF-500 51
Connections
Connectors
CAUTION
Before connecting the PF-500 to other electronic components, turn off the power to all the components. Before
turning the power on or off to all components, set all volume levels to minimum (0). Otherwise, electrical shock or
damage to the components may occur.
The PF-500s [MASTER
VOLUME] dial setting affects
the input signal from the AUX
IN jacks, but the [REVERB],
[CHORUS], and BRIL-
LIANCE [MELLOW]
[BRIGHT] (page 28) settings
do not.
If you connect the PF-500 to
a monaural device, use only
the AUX IN [L/L+R] jack or
AUX OUT [L/L+R] jack.
1 AUX IN [R], [L/L+R] jacks
The stereo outputs from another instrument can be connected to these jacks,
allowing the sound of an external instrument to be reproduced via the PF-
500’s speakers. Refer to the diagram below and use audio cables for connec-
tion.
CAUTION
When the PF-500’s AUX IN jacks are connected to an external device, first turn
on the power to the external divice, then to the PF-500. Reverse this order when
you turn the power off.
AUX PEDALAC INLET
AUX IN
R
L/L+R
MIDI
IN THRUOUT
PEDAL TO HOST USB
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
PHONES
ON OFF
POWER
RL R
L/L+R
AUX OUT
LEVEL FIXED
4 5 7 8 9
1
2
3
6
TIP
TIP
AUX IN
phone plug
(standard)
audio cable
Plug shape depends
on the divece.
AUX OUT
Tone Generator
PF-500
AUX IN
R
L/L+R
52 PF-500
Connections
Do not route the output from
the AUX OUT jacks to the
AUX IN jacks. That is, when
you connect an external
audio device to the AUX
OUT jacks, do not connect
the audio device to the PF-
500s AUX IN jacks. If you
make this connection, the
signal input at the AUX IN
jacks will be output from
AUX OUT. This creates an
audio loop, causing audio
oscillation and abnormal
playback, and leading to
malfunction of both pieces
of equipment.
Use audio cables and adap-
tor plugs with no resistance.
The PF-500s [MASTER
VOLUME] setting will not
affect the sound that is out-
put from AUX OUT (LEVEL
FIXED).
2 AUX OUT [R][L] Pin jacks (LEVEL FIXED), [R][L/L+R] Phone jacks
These jacks let you connect the PF-500 to your stereo system etc. to play at
higher volumes, or connect a cassette recorder etc. to record your playing.
Use audio cables to make connections as shown in the diagram.
CAUTION
When the PF-500’s AUX OUT jacks are connected to an external audio system,
first turn on the power to the PF-500, then to the external audio system. Reverse
this order when you turn the power off.
3 PHONES jack
See page 16.
4 PEDAL jack
See page 14.
Connect or disconnect the
pedal when the power is off.
5 AUX PEDAL jack
A separately sold FC7 foot controller or FC4/FC5 foot switch can be con-
nected to this jack. By using an FC7 you can control the volume while playing
to add expression to your performance, or control various other functions. By
using an FC4/FC5, you can switch various selected functions on/off. To select
the function that will be controlled, use the [VOICE SETTING] parameter
[AuxPedal] (See page 76). The SONG [START/STOP] function can also be
assigned to a foot switch (See page 84).
6 MIDI [IN], [OUT], [THRU] connectors
Use MIDI cables to connect external MIDI devices to these connectors.
Make sure you set the HOST SELECT switch (described on the privious page)
to MIDI when you use these connectors.
7 HOST SELECT switch
This switch should be set according to the type of connected MIDI device or
personal computer. (Refer to “Connecting a personal computer” on page 53
for more information.)
8 TO HOST jack
This jack allows direct connection to a personal computer. (Refer to “Con-
necting a personal computer” on page 53 for more information.)
9 USB jack
This jack allows direct connection to a personal computer. (Refer to “Con-
necting a personal computer” on page 53 for more information.)
CAUTION
TIP
TIP
AUX IN
phone plug
(standard)
audio cable
Stereo
To powered speakers
RCA
pin plug
RCA
pin plug
When these are connected (with stan-
dard phone plugs), you can use the
[MASTER VOLUME] control to adjust
the volume of the sound output to the
external device.
When these are connected (with RCA pin
plug; LEVEL FIXED), the sound is output to
the external device at a fixed level, regardless
of the [MASTER VOLUME] control setting.
PF-500
RL R
L/L+R
AUX OUT
LEVEL FIXED
TIP
PF-500 53
Connections
Connecting a personal computer
You can connect the [TO HOST], MIDI [IN][OUT][THRU], or [USB] connector of the PF-500 to your per-
sonal computer and enjoy using the PF-500 in conjunction with musical software on your computer.
There are the three methods by which to connect the PF-500 to a personal computer:
1. Connecting the serial port on the computer to the PF-500’s TO HOST jack (page 52)
2. Using a MIDI interface and the PF-500’s MIDI connectors (page 52)
3. Connecting the USB port on the computer to the PF-500’s USB jack (page 52)
For more information, refer to the following pages.
When connecting the PF-500 to a personal computer, rst turn off the power to both the PF-500 and the computer before
connecting any cables and setting the HOST SELECT switch. After making connections and switch settings, turn on the
power to the computer rst, then to the PF-500.
If you are not using the connection between the PF-500 and your computer, you must disconnect the cable from the [TO
HOST] jack or [USB] jack. The PF-500 may not operate correctly if a cable is left connected.
The connectors that can be used will depend on the setting of the HOST SELECT switch.
HOST SELECT switch setting Usable connectors
[MIDI] [MIDI] connectors (all: [IN][OUT][THRU])
[PC-2], [Mac] [TO HOST] jack
[USB] [USB] jack
TIP
TIP
TIP
54 PF-500
Connections
1. Connecting the serial port on the computer to the PF-500’s TO HOST jack
Connect the computer’s serial port (RS-232C or RS-422) to the PF-500’s TO HOST jack.
In this connection, the PF-500 functions as a MIDI interface. Therefore, you do not need a special
MIDI interface.
Connection
Use a special serial cable (page 55) to connect the computer’s serial port (RS-232C or RS-422) to the PF-500’s
TO HOST jack.
TO HOST
Windows Windows Macintosh
modem portRS-232C (D-sub 9-pin) RS-232C (D-sub 25-pin)
PF-500
TO HOST
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
Note for Windows users (regarding the MIDI driver)
To transfer data via the computer’s serial port and the PF-500’s TO HOST jack, you need to install a spe-
cific MIDI driver (the Yamaha CBX driver for Windows). You can download this driver from XG Library
on the Yamaha Web site (http://www.yamaha-xg.com) or install from the Accessory CD-ROM included
with the PF-500.
PF-500 55
Connections
Type of serial cables and connection pin assignments
According to the type of computer you connect, use one of the following serial cables.
PF-500 HOST SELECT switch setting
Set the PF-500 HOST SELECT switch properly according to the type of connected computer.
Macintosh: “Mac” (data transfer rate: 31,250bps, 1MHz clock)
Windows: “PC-2” (data transfer rate: 38,400bps)
If your system does not work properly with the connections and settings listed above, your software may require different
settings. Check your software operation manual and set the HOST SELECT switch to the proper data transfer rate.
8 (CTS)
7 (RTS)
2 (RxD)
5 (GND)
3 (TxD)
1
2
3
4
8
5
Windows (with a serial port of D-sub 9-pin)
8-pin mini DIN plug D-sub 9-pin plug
(Yamaha CCJ-PC2 or equivalent)
mini DIN
8-pin
D-sub
9-pin
mini DIN
8-pin
2 (HSK i)
1 (HSK O)
5 (RxD-)
4 (GND)
3 (TxD-)
8 (RxD+)
7 (GP-)
6 (TxD+)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
mini DIN
8-pin
Macintosh
System peripheral plug 8-pin plug
(Yamaha CCJ-MAC or equivalent)
mini DIN
8-pin
5 (CTS)
4 (RTS)
3 (RxD)
7 (GND)
2 (TxD)
1
2
3
4
8
5
D-sub
25-pin
Windows (with a serial port of D-sub 25-pin)
8-pin mini DIN plug D-sub 25-pin plug
(Yamaha CCJ-PC1NF or equivalent)
mini DIN 8-pin D-sub 25-pin
Pin numbers (view from front)
D-sub 9-pin
1
1234567891011
14 15 16 17
45321
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
12 13
34
67
8
5
2
9876
Pin assignment
The following diagram shows the pin assignments
for each cable.
TIP
56 PF-500
Connections
2. Using a MIDI interface and the PF-500’s MIDI connectors
Connection
Use a MIDI interface device to connect a computer to the PF-500 using special MIDI cables.
PF-500 HOST SELECT switch setting
Set the PF-500 HOST SELECT switch to “MIDI.
MIDI OUT
MIDI
IN
Windows
Macintosh
MIDI
OUT
MIDI
OUT
MIDI
IN
MIDI
IN
MIDI interface
MIDI interface
PF-500
MIDI
IN THRUOUT
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
PF-500 57
Connections
3. Connecting the USB port on the computer to the PF-500’s USB jack
If you connect the PF-500 to your computer, you can transfer MIDI data between your computer and
the PF-500. You can also use the included File Utility (software for your computer) to transfer files
between your computer and the internal memory of the PF-500.
Connections
Use a USB cable to connect the USB port on your computer to the [USB] jack on the PF-500.
There are two types of USB connectors: A and B. The USB jack on the PF-500 accepts a B-type connector. Connect the
A-type connector of the USB cable to the USB port on your computer. Connect the B-type connector to the USB jack on
the PF-500.
PF-500 HOST SELECT switch setting
Set the PF-500 HOST SELECT switch to “USB.
PF-500
computer
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
SONG KEYBOARD
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
SPLIT CHORUSREVERB
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
VOICE
SETTING
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
SONG
SETTING
FILE
C
A
D
B
UPDOWN
E.BASS XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
VOICE
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
TRACK
1
TOP
SYNCHRO START
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
SONG
MAXMIN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
EXIT
CONTRAST
EFFECT
TO HOST USB
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
USB cable
TIP
About the USB driver
You must install the specified USB driver (YAMAHA USB MIDI Driver) in your computer before you can
transfer data between the computer and the PF-500.
The YAMAHA USB MIDI Driver can be installed from the Accessory CD-ROM included with the PF-500.
The YAMAHA USB MIDI Driver supports the following OS versions.
Windows 98, Windows 98SE, Windows Me, Windows 2000, Windows XP
Mac OS 8.6–9.2.1
58 PF-500
Connections
About the USB connector
In order to use MIDI on your computer, you will need application software that is appropriate for your
computer and that meets your needs.
If you want to use a USB cable to connect the PF-500 to your computer, you must connect the USB
cable before turning on the power of the PF-500.
Also, do not turn the power of the PF-500 on or off while application software that uses USB MIDI is
running.
The PF-500 will begin transmission a short time after the USB connection is made.
If you are using Windows 2000, problems may occur on your computer when your computer starts up.
In this case, turn on the power of the PF-500 when your computer is running.
When using a USB cable to connect the PF-500 to your computer, make the connection directly without
passing through a USB hub.
Depending on the state of your computer, the operating state of the PF-500 may become unstable. Do
not use your computer in a way that causes it to enter an unstable state.
CAUTION
If you turn the power of the PF-500 on/off or connect/disconnect the USB cable in the following states,
problems will occur in the computer system, possibly causing it to “freeze (hang up), or causing the
PF-500 to stop functioning.
- While installing the driver
- While starting-up or shutting-down the operating system
- While your computer is suspended (sleeping)
- While a MIDI application is running
Performing the following actions may cause your computer to hang up or the PF-500 to stop function-
ing.
- Rapidly turning the power on/off or connecting/disconnecting the cable
- Shifting to power-conservation (sleep) mode while MIDI data is being transferred, or returning from
sleep mode
- Connecting/disconnecting the cable while the power of the PF-500 is on
- Turning the power of the PF-500 on/off, starting up your computer, or installing the driver while a
large amount of data is being transferred
PF-500 59
Detailed Settings
60 PF-500
Detailed Settings
You can set various parameters to make the best use of PF-500 functions, such as fine tuning the pitch, select-
ing a voice for the metronome, repeating playback, etc. For the basic procedure to make these settings, refer
to page 85.
Parameter List
The following parameters are available.
Recording and playback [SONG SETTING]
Metronome METRONOME [SETTING]
Settings Parameter name Reference page
Correcting note timing Quantize 65
Specifying whether playback starts immediately
along with the rst voicing
QuickPlay 66
Auditioning the channels ChannelListen 66
Deleting data by each channel ChannelClear 66
Specifying the range and playing back repeatedly FromToRepeat 66
Playing back the phrase specied by the phrase
number
PhraseMark 67
Playing back a song repeatedly SongRepeat 67
Settings Parameter name Reference page
Metronome time signature TimeSignature 68
Metronome volume level MetronomeVolume 68
Metronome voice MetronomeSound 68
PF-500 61
Detailed Settings
Voices [VOICE SETTING]
In Dual mode, parameters with the mark are set for Voice 1 and Voice 2 individually.
Settings Parameter name Reference page
Octave* Octave 70
Volume level* Volume 70
Position of right and left channels* Pan 70
Fine pitch adjustment (only in Dual mode) Detune 70
Reverb type ReverbType 71
Reverb depth* ReverbSend 71
Chorus type ChorusType 71
Chorus depth* ChorusSend 71
Chorus on/off ChorusOnOff 72
Select the DSP type* DSP Type (DSP) 72
Set the speed of the vibraphone vibrato effect* VibeRotorSpeed 72
Turn the vibraphone vibrato effect on/off* VibeRotorOnOff (RotorOnOff) 73
Adjust the speed of the rotary speaker* RotarySpeed (Rot.Speed) 73
Adjust the DSP effect depth* DSPDepth 73
Adjust the brightness of the sound* Brightness 73
Adjust the resonance effect* HarmonicContent (Harmonic) 73
Adjust the low-range frequency of the equalizer* EQ LowFreq. (EQ L.Freq) 74
Adjust the low-range gain (boost/cut) of the equal-
izer*
EQ LowGain 74
Adjust the high-range frequency of the equalizer* EQ HighFreq. (EQ H.Freq) 74
Adjust the high-range gain (boost/cut) of the equal-
izer*
EQ HighGain 74
Touch sensitivity* TouchSense 75
Right pedal function RPedal 75
Center pedal function MPedal 75
Left pedal function LPedal 76
Auxiliary pedal function AuxPedal 76
*
62 PF-500
Detailed Settings
MIDI [MIDI SETTING]
[OTHER SETTING]
Settings Parameter name Reference page
MIDI transmit channel MidiOutChannel 78
Specify the MIDI receive channel MidiInChannel 78
Local control on/off LocalControl 79
Selecting performance from the keyboard or song
data for MIDI transmission
MidiOutSelect 79
Type of data received via MIDI ReceiveParameter 79
Type of data transmitted via MIDI TransmitParameter 79
Song data bulk dump SongBulkDump 80
Transmitting the initial settings InitialSetup 80
Voice data bulk dump VoiceBulkDump 80
Settings Parameter name Reference page
Selecting a touch response TouchResponse 81
Make ne pitch adjustments Tune 81
Selecting a tuning curve for a piano voice PianoTuningCurve 81
Selecting a scale Scale 82
Specifying the Split Point SplitPoint 82
Change the key Transpose 82
Specify the depth of the Soft pedal SoftPedalDepth 83
Depth of string resonance StringResonanceDepth 83
Depth of sustain sampling for the damper pedal SustainSamplingDepth 83
Specify the volume of the key-off sound KeyOffSamplingDepth 83
Selecting a pedal function for vibraphone VibraphonePedalMode 83
Assign the SONG [START/STOP] function to the
pedal
PedalStart/Srop 84
Selecting a type of auxiliary pedal AuxPedalType 84
Setting the point at which the damper pedal starts
to affect the sound
HalfPedalPoint 84
Pitch bend range PitchBendRange 84
Switch the speaker on/off Speaker 85
Selecting the items saved at the time of shutdown MemoryBackUp 85
Restoring the normal (default) settings FactorySet 85
PF-500 63
Detailed Settings
Making detailed settings
Procedure
1. Access a setting menu.
Press the desired setting button ([SONG SETTING], MET-
RONOME [SETTING], [VOICE SETTING], [MIDI SETTING],
or [OTHER SETTING]) to access the corresponding setting
menu.
Press the [EXIT] button any time to close the setting menu.
2. Select the desired parameter or part.
Press the setting button, A [–]/[+], and/or C [–]/[+] but-
tons repeatedly as required.
3. Set the parameter or part.
Some parameters or parts lead you to more options. Use
the B [– (NO)]/[+ (YES)], C [–]/[+], and D [–]/[+] buttons
to select or set the option.
To restore the normal parameter value, press the [–] and [+] buttons
simultaneously.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
1
1
2 3 5
2
3
3 4
1
11
64 PF-500
Detailed Settings
4. Write, execute, or save the data.
There are two ways to respond to the messages.
If “Execute?” or “Start?” appears:
Press the B [+(YES)] button to display confirmation ([Sure?]). To
proceed, press the B [+(YES)] button again. The PF-500 displays
“Executing” and writes the data. When the operation is complete, it
displays “Completed” for three seconds, then returns to the previous
screen.
To cancel the operation, press the B [–(NO)] button instead of the B
[+(YES)] button.
If “Set?” appears:
Press the B [+(YES)] button to execute the setting. The PF-500 dis-
plays “Executing and saves the data. When the operation is complete,
it displays “Completed” for three seconds, then returns to the previ-
ous screen.
However, the “Completed” display that appears when [VoiceBulk-
Dump] (page 80) is finished will not change back to the previous dis-
play after three seconds. Press any button on the panel to return to the
previous display.
5. Close the setting menu.
Press the [EXIT] button.
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 65
Detailed settings for recording
and playback [SONG SETTING]
You can make detailed settings for the selected song. First, select the desired song from preset songs (“Preset-
Song”) or memory songs (“MemorySong”) (see page 48).
Procedure
Select the desired song and press the [SONG SETTING] button to access the “Song Setting”
menu.
You can correct the timing of notes. For example,
you can adjust recorded notes to precise eighth or
sixteenth notes, or make the entire feel of a song
more lively (with a swing type of rhythm).
Changes are made by song.
You can also listen to the sound while changing
the setting. To change the data, you need to
respond to “Execute?
.”
See the procedure on page 63.
Notes for which you can adjust the timing:
If you select “1/8” or “1/16” for correction, the PF-
500 displays “SwingRate=xx%”, which enables you
to make the entire feel of a song more lively and
swinging.
Setting range:
0% - 100%
If you select “1/8” for correction:
Save the edited song data to memory. (See page 45.)
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
[SONG SETTING]
Correcting note timing
[Quantize]
C
A
D
B
Specifies the type of note.
Stores the changed value.
NO YES
3
3
[OFF]
[1/4]
[1/8]
[1/12]
[1/16]
[1/24]
quarter note
eighth note
eighth note triplets
sixteenth note
sixteenth note triplets
3 3
Performance data
Swing rate = 50% : not swinging
Swing rate = 75% (51% or higher) :
The timing of even beat notes is slightly delayed.
Swing rate = 25% (49% or lower) :
The timing of even beat notes is slightly early.
Swing rate = 67% :
The timing of the even beat notes is moved to
the third beat of the triplets.
TIP
66 PF-500
Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING]
This parameter enables you to specify whether a
song that starts from the middle of a bar, or a song
with a silence prior to the first note, should be
played from the first note or from the top of the bar
(rest or blank).
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
[On] Playing from the first note
[Off] Playing from the top of the bar (including a
rest or blank)
You can select a single channel to listen to its con-
tents. Playback starts from the first note.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Ch1 - Ch16
Usually, channels that do not contain any data are not
displayed. However, for some songs, all channels
(including the channels that contain no data) may be dis-
played.
You can delete data from each of 16 channels.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Ch1 - Ch16, ALL (all channels)
Channels that do not contain any data are not dis-
played. However, for some songs, all channels
(including the channels that contain no data) may be
displayed.
Save the edited song data to memory. (See page 45.)
You can specify a range (in steps of beats) in a song
to play back repeatedly.
Playback repeats after it reaches just prior to the
beat specified as the end point.
If you start playing back a song with “Repeat
On selected, the count down starts, followed by
the repeated playback of the specified part until
you press the [TOP] button.
If you select “Repeat Off, normal playback starts.
See the procedure on page 63.
Specifying whether playback
starts immediately along with
the first voicing [QuickPlay]
Auditioning the channels
[ChannelListen]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
Use these buttons to select the
desired channel for playback.
Playback continues as long
as you press and hold down this button.
NO YES
TIP
Deleting data from each chan-
nel [ChannelClear]
Specifying the range and play-
ing back repeatedly [From-
ToRepeat]
C
A
D
B
Press this button to delete data.
Use these buttons to select the
desired channel for deletion.
NO YES
TIP
C
A
D
B
Use these buttons
to specify the end point
of the repeated range.
Use these buttons to select Repeat On.
Use these buttons
to specify the start point
of the repeated range.
NO YES
PF-500 67
Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING]
Use the following buttons to specify the range to be
repeated during song playback.
C [][+] ........ species the start point of the repeat.
D []/[+] .......species the end point of the repeat.
When you select another song, the specied range is auto-
matically cancelled and the Repeat function is turned off.
If you select a song that contains phrase mark data,
you can specify phrase numbers in the score to play
back from the mark point, or to play back the
phrase repeatedly.
If you start playing back a song with “Repeat
On selected, the count down starts, followed by
the repeated playback of the specified phrase
until you press the [TOP] button.
If you select “Repeat Off, normal playback
starts from the specified phrase.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range of the phrase number:
Off (not specified)
1 - the last phrase number of the song
If you select a song that dose not contain phrase
mark data, you can select only “Off.
You can repeatedly play back all songs or a single
song selected from the 50 preset songs.
When you start playback, the PF-500 plays the
song you selected using the front panel, then
starts repeat playback of the specified songs until
you press the [TOP] button.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
[MemorySongs] All songs in the PF-500’s mem-
ory
[PresetSongs] All 50 preset songs
[ALL] All songs from “MemorySongs”
and “PresetSongs”
[OneSong] One song selected from the front
panel
Playing back the phrase speci-
fied by the phrase number
[PhraseMark]
TIP
NOTE
C
A
D
B
Use these buttons to specify the phrase number.
Use these buttons to select Repeat On.
NO YES
Playing back a song repeatedly
[SongRepeat]
C
A
D
B
Use these buttons to specify the repeated songs.
Use these buttons to select On.
NO YES
68 PF-500
Detailed settings for the metro-
nome METRONOME [SETTING]
You can set the time signature, volume level, and voice of the PF-500 metronome.
Procedure
Press the [METRONOME SETTING] button to access the Metronome Setting menu.
See the procedure on page 63.
For example, to specify “3/4, use the C [–]/[+]
buttons to select “3” and the D [–]/[+] buttons to
select “4.
Setting range for the numerator:
1 - 16
Setting options for the denominator:
2, 4, and 8
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
0-127
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
[BellOff] Click (standard metronome
sound)
[EnglishVoice] Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in English
[GermanVoice] Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in German
[JapaneseVoice] Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in Japa-
nese
[FrenchVoice] Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in French
[SpanishVoice] Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in Spanish
[BellOn] Click and bell
To mute the beat count, select BellOff.
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
[METRONOME SETTING]
Setting the metronome time
signature [TimeSignature]
Setting the metronome vol-
ume level [MetronomeVol-
ume]
C
A
D
B
Use these buttons
to set the denominator
of the time signature.
Use these buttons
to set the numerator
of the time signature.
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Selecting the metronome
voice [MetronomeSound]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TIP
PF-500 69
Detailed settings for the voices
[VOICE SETTING]
This menu enables you to make various detailed settings for the voices in Dual or Split mode and the effects.
You can make these settings for each voice (or each combination of voices) individually. You can listen to the
notes you play on the keyboard while changing the settings.
Procedure
1. Select a voice and press the [VOICE SETTING] button to access the “Voice Set-
ting” menu.
2. Press the A [–]/[+] buttons to select the part for which you wish to change the
voice.
The range of the displayed part varies depending on the selected voice.
[Main] MAIN voices (displayed with a single voice or in Split mode)
[Main
× Layer] MAIN Voice 1 and Voice 2 (displayed when the MAIN side is in Dual mode)
[Left] LEFT voice (displayed in Split mode)
[Left
× Layer] LEFT Voice 1 and Voice 2 (displayed when the LEFT side is in Dual mode)
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
[VOICE SETTING]
70 PF-500
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]
In Dual mode, parameters with the * mark are set for
Voice 1 and Voice 2 individually.
Parameter names enclosed in parentheses ( ) are dis-
played in Dual mode.
The pitch of a note can be shifted upward or down-
ward in steps of an octave.
See the procedure on page 63.
In Dual mode:
Setting range:
–2 (two octaves lower) - 0 (no pitch shift) - +2
(two octaves higher)
You can set the volume level for each voice part.
See the procedure on page 63.
In Dual mode:
Setting range:
0 - 127
You can specify the position in the stereo image
from which you hear the sound.
See the procedure on page 63.
In Dual mode:
Setting range:
L64 (hard left) - C (center) - R63 (hard right)
The pitch of the two sounds selected in Dual mode
can be “skewed” slightly away from each other.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
–20–+20 (Positive (+) settings will raise the pitch
of the first sound and lower the pitch of the second
sound. Negative (–) settings will do the opposite.)
Setting the octave [Octave]*
Setting the volume level
[Volume]*
TIP
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2)
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
Voice for editing (Voice 1 and Voice 2)
NO YES
Setting the position of right
and left channels [Pan]*
Make fine adjustments to the
pitch (only in Dual mode)
[Detune]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2)
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 71
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]
You cannot set this parameter for the voice parts Left
and LeftXLayer.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Room Simulates reverberation in a room.
Hall1 Simulates reverberation in a concert hall.
Hall2 Reverberation is slightly longer than that of
“Hall1.
Stage Reverberation suitable for a solo instru-
ment sound.
Plate Reverberation from the vibration of a
metal plate.
The reverb effect is not applied if the ReverbSend
parameter is set to 0.
See the procedure on page 63.
In Dual mode:
Setting range:
0 - 127
You cannot set this parameter for the voice parts Left
and Left
× Layer.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Chorus Adds a rich, spacious sound.
Celeste Adds swell and a spacious sound.
Flanger Adds swell effects of an ascending or
descending jet plane.
See the procedure on page 63.
In Dual mode:
Setting range:
0 - 127
Selecting the reverb type
[ReverbType]
Setting the reverb depth
[ReverbSend]*
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2)
NO YES
Selecting the chorus type
[Chorus Type]
Setting the chorus depth
[ChorusSend]*
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2)
NO YES
72 PF-500
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]
You can set the [CHORUS] button on or off for
each voice. When you select a voice, the chorus on/
off setting for the voice automatically changes
according to this parameter.
Even if this parameter is turned on, the chorus effect is
disabled if the ChorusSend parameter is set to 0.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
On/Off
You can select other effects (than reverb and cho-
rus).
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
DelayLCR Delay applied at left, center, and
right positions.
DelayLR Delay applied at left and right
positions.
Echo Echo-like delay
CrossDelay Left and right delays are crossed.
Symphonic Adds a rich and deep acoustic
effect.
RotarySpeaker Adds the vibrato effect of a rotary
speaker.
Tremolo The volume level changes in
rapid cycles.
VibeRotor The vibrato effect of a vibra-
phone.
AutoPan The sound pans left to right and
back and forth.
Phaser The phase changes periodically,
swelling the sound.
AutoWah The center frequency of the wah
filter changes periodically.
SoundBoardRev Simulates the reverberation of a
piano soundboard.
Off No effect.
Rotor= The rotating portion of an electrical device etc.
This will be displayed only if VibeRotor is selected
for the DSP Type parameter explained above.
This sets the speed of the vibrato effect that is
applied when you have selected Vibraphone and
are using the VibeRotor pedal.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
1–10
Setting the chorus on/off
[ChorusOnOff]
Selecting the DSP type*
[DSP Type (DSP)]
TIP
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Setting the speed of the vibra-
phone vibrato effect* [VibeRo-
torSpeed]
TERMINOLOGY
PF-500 73
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]
This will be displayed only if VibeRotor is selected
for the DSP Type parameter explained above.
It turns on/off the vibrato effect that is applied
when you use the VibeRotor pedal.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
On/Off
This will be displayed only if RotarySpeaker is
selected for the DSP Type parameter explained above.
It sets the rotation speed of the rotary speaker effect.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Slow/Fast
This sets the depth of the DSP effect (page 72).
Some DSP Type settings do not allow you to set the
DSPDepth.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
1 (output only the original sound with almost no
effect applied)–127 (output only the sound pro-
cessed by the effect)
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
–64–+63
Resonance= Sympathetic vibration
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
–64–+63
Turning the vibraphone
vibrato effect on/off* [VibeRo-
torOnOff (RotorOnOff)]
Setting the rotation speed of
the rotary speaker* [Rota-
rySpeed (Rot.Speed)]
Adjusting the depth of the
DSP effect* [DSPDepth]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Adjusting the brightness of the
sound* [Brightness]
Adjusting the resonance
effect* [HarmonicContent
(Harmonic)]
TERMINOLOGY
74 PF-500
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]
Equalizer:
An audio equalizer divides the frequency spectrum into
multiple regions and enables the user to adjust the rela-
tive amplitude of each region.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
32 Hz–2.0 kHz
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
–12–+12 dB
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
500 Hz–16.0 kHz
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
–12–+12 dB
Adjusting the low-range fre-
quency of the equalizer*
[EQ LowFreq. (EQ L.Freq)]
Adjusting the low-range gain
(amount of boost/cut) of the
equalizer* [EQ LowGain]
TERMINOLOGY
Low Gain
High Gain
Low Freq. High Freq.
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Adjusting the high-range fre-
quency of the equalizer*
[EQ HighFreq. (EQ H.Freq)]
Adjusting the high-range gain
(amount of boost/cut) of the
equalizer* [EQ HighGain]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 75
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]
This parameter enables determines the manner
and degree to which the volume level changes in
response to your touch on the keyboard (how hard
you play). Since the volume level of the harpsi-
chords and pipe organs do not change regardless of
how you play the keyboard, the normal setting for
these voices is 127. (See the setting range below.)
See the procedure on page 63.
In Dual mode:
Setting range:
0 (softest) - 64 (largest changes in the level) - 127
(loudest and fixed)
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Sustain ON/OFF switch type damper
SustainCont Damper that sustains the sound
proportionately to how deeply
you press the pedal
Sostenuto Sostenuto (page 27)
Soft Soft (page 27)
Expression A function that lets you create
changes in dynamics (volume) as
you play
PitchBend Up A function that smoothly raises
the pitch
PitchBend Down
A function that smoothly lowers
the pitch
RotarySpeed Change the rotational speed of
the JazzOrgan rotary speaker
(switch between fast/slow each
time you press the pedal)
Viberotor Switch the vibraphone vibrato
on/off (switch on/off each time
you press the pedal)
Off No function
Normal setting:
SustainCont
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Same as “Specifying the function of the right
pedal, above.
Normal Setting:
Sostenuto
Setting the touch sensitivity
[TouchSense]*
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2)
Setting the right pedal func-
tion [RPedal]
Setting the center pedal func-
tion [MPedal]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
76 PF-500
Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Same as “Right pedal function assignment
(page 75).
Normal Setting:
Soft (for all voices other than JazzOrgan and
VibraPhone)
Rotary Speed (JazzOrgan), Vibraphone (VibeRo-
tor)
You can assign a function to the pedal connected to
the PF-500’s AUX PEDAL jack.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Same as “Right pedal function assignment
(page 75).
Normal setting:
Expression
YAMAHA FC7 foot controller
This foot controller is suitable for controlling Expression,
SustainCont, or PitchBend Up/Down.
YAMAHA FC4 foot switch
YAMAHA FC5 foot switch
These foot switches are suitable for controlling Sustain,
Sostenuto, Soft, RotarySpeed, or VibeRotor.
Setting the left pedal function
[LPedal]
Setting the auxiliary pedal
function [AuxPedal]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
TIP
PF-500 77
MIDI [MIDI SETTING]
You can make detailed MIDI settings, such as setting up MIDI transmit/receive channels.
About MIDI
MIDI (Musical Instrument Digital Interface) is a standard format for data transmission/reception. It
enables the transfer of performance data and commands between MIDI devices and personal computers.
Using MIDI, you can control a connected MIDI device from the PF-500, or control the PF-500 from a con-
nected MIDI device or computer.
MIDI connectors
MIDI [IN]: Receives MIDI data.
MIDI [OUT]: Transmits MIDI data.
MIDI [THRU]: Transmits data received at the MIDI [IN] connector as it is.
Prepare dedicated MIDI cables.
[TO HOST] connector
Use this connector to connect the PF-500 to a computer.
The type connecting cable varies depending on the computer. Refer to Connect-
ing a Personal Computer on page 53 for more information.
[USB] connector
Use this connector to connect the PF-500 and computer.
MIDI
IN THRUOUT
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
TIP
TO HOST
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
TIP
TO HOST USB
HOST SELECT
MIDI PC-2 USBMac
MIDI performance data and
commands are transferred in
the form of numeric values.
Since MIDI data that can be
transmitted or received var-
ies depending on the type of
MIDI device, check the MIDI
Implementation Chart to nd
out what MIDI data and com-
mands your devices can
transmit or receive. The PF-
500s MIDI Implementation
Chart is listed on page 32 in
the Reference Booklet for
the PF-500.
When you are using the
MIDI connectors, set the
[HOST SELECT] switch to
MIDI. (See page 52.)
When you are using the [TO
HOST] connector, set the
[HOST SELECT] switch cor-
rectly, according to the type
of computer you are using.
(See page 52.)
When you are using the
[USB] connector, set the
[HOST SELECT] switch to
USB.
You can also obtain detailed
information about MIDI from
various music magazines
and books.
TIP
TIP
NOTE
TIP
78 PF-500
MIDI [MIDI SETTING]
Procedure
Press the [MIDI SETTING] button to enter MIDI setting mode.
This parameter enables you to specify the channel
on which the PF-500 transmits MIDI data.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting for:
Main, Left, Layer, Left Layer
Setting range:
Ch1 - Ch16, Off (Not transmitted.)
Normal setting:
Main — Ch1
Left — Ch2
Layer — Ch3
Left Layer— Ch4
You can specify whether each channel of data from
MIDI [IN], [TO HOST], and [USB] will be
received.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting for:
Ch1 - Ch32
Setting range:
Song, Main, Left, Layer, LeftLayer, Keyboard, Off
Normal setting:
Ch1–16 Song
Ch17 Keyboard
Ch18 Main
Ch19 Left
Ch20 Layer
Ch21 LeftLayer
Others Off
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VAR IATI ON BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
[MIDI SETTING]
Setting the MIDI transmit
channel [MidiOutChannel]
C
A
D
B
Select a voice part.
Specify the channel.
NO YES
Setting the MIDI receive chan-
nel [MidiInChannel]
C
A
D
B
Select a channel. Select a MIDI
receive part.
NO YES
MIDI IN
TO HOST
Sound source A
Channels 1-16
Port A Port B
Sound source B
Channels 17-32
MIDI data
Used for song
playback
Only for song
playback
(When the channel
setting is other
than Song or Off)
Played from
the keyboard
USB
PF-500 79
MIDI [MIDI SETTING]
“Local Control On is a state in which the PF-500
produces the sound from its tone generator when
you play the keyboard. In “Local Control Off
state, the keyboard and the tone generator are cut
off from each other. This means that even if you
play the keyboard, the PF-500 will not produce the
sound. Instead, the keyboard data can be transmit-
ted via MIDI to a connected MIDI device, which
can produce the sound. The “Local Control Off
setting is useful when you wish to play an external
sound source while playing the keys on the PF-500.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
On/Off
Normal setting:
On
You can select whether your performance data or
song playback data (including demo songs) is sent
via MIDI.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Keyboard performance data played on the key-
board
Song song playback data
Normal setting:
Keyboard
This parameter enables you to specify which MIDI
data the PF-500 can receive.
See the procedure on page 63.
Type of data:
Note, Control, Program, Pitch Bend, SysEx (Sys-
tem Exclusive)
Setting range:
On/Off
Normal setting:
On for all types of data
This parameter enables you to specify which MIDI
data the PF-500 can transmit.
See the procedure on page 63.
Type of data:
Note, Control, Program, Pitch Bend, SystemReal-
Time, SysEx (System Exclusive)
Setting range:
On/Off
Normal setting:
On for all types of data
Setting Local control on/off
[LocalControl]
Selecting performance from
the keyboard or song data for
MIDI transmission [MidiOutSe-
lect]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Selecting a type of data
received via MIDI [ReceivePa-
rameter]
Selecting a type of data trans-
mitted via MIDI [TransmitPa-
rameter]
C
A
D
B
Select a type of data.
Select On or Off.
NO YES
C
A
D
B
Select a type of data.
Select On or Off.
NO YES
80 PF-500
MIDI [MIDI SETTING]
You can transmit the panel data, such as voice
selection, to a connected sequencer. Before you
record performance data to a connected MDF3 or
sequencer, it is useful if you first send and record
(at the beginning of the performance data) the
panel setup data for your performance during
playback.
See the procedure on page 63.
You can transmit the voice data specified in the
“Voice Setting menu (page 69) as MIDI bulk data.
You can interrupt voice data bulk dump transmis-
sion by pressing the B [– (NO)] button.
See the procedure on page 63.
Transmitting the initial set-
tings on the panel [Ini-
tialSetup]
Executing voice data bulk
dump [VoiceBulkDump]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 81
Other settings
You can make detailed settings for touch, tuning, scale, etc.
Procedure
Press the [OTHER SETTING] button to enter Other Setting mode.
You can specify a touch response (how the sound
responds to the way you play the keys).
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Light With a soft touch, the PF-500 produces a
loud sound. The volume level of tones
tends to be consistent.
Medium Standard touch response.
Heavy You must hit the key very hard to gener-
ate a loud volume. This allows for versa-
tile expression, from pianissimo to
fortissimo tones.
Fixed No touch response. The volume level will
be the same regardless of how hard you
play the keys. Use the B [–]/[+] buttons
to set the volume level.
Setting range of the “Fixed” volume level:
1 - 127
You can fine tune the pitch of the entire instru-
ment. This function is useful when you play the
PF-500 along with other instruments or CD music.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
A3=427.0Hz - 453.0Hz (0.1Hz steps)
You can select a tuning curve from “GrandPiano1”
and “GrandPiano2. Select “Flat if you feel the
tuning curve of the piano voice does not quite
match that of other instruments voices.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Stretch Tuning curve particularly for pianos
Flat Tuning curve in which the frequency is
octave doubled over the entire keyboard
range
SONG KEYBOARD
GRAND
PIANO 1
CHURCH
ORGAN
E.PIANO
1
STRINGS
E.PIANO
2
CHOIR
GRAND
PIANO 2
JAZZ
ORGAN
HARPSI-
CHORD
SYNTH.
PAD
VIBRA-
PHONE
E.BASS
XG
GUITAR
E.CLAVI-
CHORD
WOOD
BASS
SONG SELECT
NEW SONG
SONG
SETTING
FILE
TRACK
1
TOP
TRACK
2
START
/
STOP
EXTRA
TRACKS
REC
UPDOWN
SETTINGSTART/STOP
METRONOME
D
B
C
A
EXITEXIT
CONTRAST
VOICE
SETTING
SPLIT
VARIATION BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
REVERB CHORUS
DEMO TEMPO
SONG BALANCEMASTER VOLUME
NO YES
VOICE
SYNCHRO START
SONG
MAXMIN
EFFECT
[OTHER SETTING]
Selecting a touch response
[TouchResponse]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Fine tuning the pitch [Tune]
Selecting a tuning curve for a
piano voice [PianoTuningCurve]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
82 PF-500
Other settings
You can select various scales.
Equal Temperament is the most common contem-
porary piano tuning scale. However, history has
known numerous other scales, many of which
serve as the basis for certain genres of music. You
can experience the tunings of these genres.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Equal
One octave is divided into twelve equal
intervals. Currently most popular piano
tuning scale.
PureMajor/PureMinor
Based on natural overtones, three major
chords using these scales produce a beauti-
ful, pure sound. They are sometimes used
for chorus parts.
Pythagorean
This scale, designed by Pythagoras, a Greek
philosopher, is based on the interval of a
perfect 5th. The 3rd produces swells, but
the 4th and 5th are beautiful and suitable
for some leads.
MeanTone
This scale is an improvement of the
Pythagorean in that the swell of the 3rd has
been eliminated. It spread during the late
16th century through the late 18th century.
Handel used this scale.
WerckMeister/KirnBerger
These scales combine Mean Tone and
Pythagorean in different ways. With these
scales, modulation changes the impression
and feel of the songs. They were often used
in the era of Bach and Beethoven. They are
also often used now to reproduce the music
of that era on harpsichords.
Normal setting:
Equal
If you select a scale other than Equal, you need to
specify the root note using the B [–]/[+] buttons.
Setting range:
C, C
, D, E
, E, F, F
, G, A
, A, B
, B
You can specify the split point (the boundary between
the right-hand and left-hand keyboard areas).
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
A-1–C7
You can also use [SPLIT] to set the split point. (page 33)
TRANSPOSE= To change the key
(Changing the key: To raise or lower the overall pitch of
the entire song.)
The PF-500s Transpose function makes it possible to
shift the pitch of the entire keyboard up or down in semi-
tone intervals to facilitate playing in difcult key signa-
tures, and to let you easily match the pitch of the
keyboard to the range of a singer or other instruments.
For example, if you set the transposition amount to 5,
playing key C produces pitch F. In this way, you can play
the song as if it were in C major, and the PF-500 will
transpose it to the key of F.
Setting for:
Master The sound of the entire instrument
(the manually-played sound and the
song playback)
Keyboard The manually-played sound
Song The song playback
Selecting a scale [Scale]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Specifying the Split Point
[SplitPoint]
Changing the key [Transpose]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
NOTE
TIP
PF-500 83
Other settings
Setting range:
–12 (–1 octave)–0 (normal pitch)–+12 (+1 octave)
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
1–10
This parameter is effective on the voices, such as
“Grand Piano 1.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Off, 1 - 10
This parameter is effective only on the voice group
“GRANDPIANO1.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Off, 1 - 10
You can adjust the volume of the key-off sound (the
subtle sound that occurs when you release a key)
This is effective on the voice groups “Grand
Piano1, “Harpsichord, and “E.Clavichord” and
on the voice “E.Piano2.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Off, 1 - 10
This parameter enables you to select whether the
sound is sustained while you press the keys on the
keyboard (“PianoLike”) or the sound is sustained
only while you press and hold down the sustain
pedal, like playing a real vibraphone (“Normal”).
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
PianoLike, Normal
Normal setting:
PianoLike
Adjusting the depth of the
Soft pedal [SoftPedalDepth]
Depth of string resonance
[StringResonanceDepth]
Depth of sustain sampling for
the damper pedal [Sustain-
SamplingDepth]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Specify the volume of the key-
off sound [KeyOffSam-
plingDepth]
Selecting a pedal function for
vibraphone [VibraphonePed-
alMode]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
84 PF-500
Other settings
If you assign the SONG START/STOP function to a
pedal and turn the function On, the pedal function
assigned to the pedal in the Voice Setting menu (pages
75 and 76) is disabled.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting for:
Left, Middle, AUX
Setting range:
On/Off
Normal setting:
Off for all pedals
A pedal connected to the [AUX PEDAL] connector
may switch on and off differently. For example,
some pedals turn on the effects and others turn
them off when you press them.
Use this parameter to reverse this mechanism.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
Make, Break
Here you can specify the point to which you must
depress the pedal (right, center, left, AUX) before the
assigned effect begins to be applied. (This setting
applies to effects that can be assigned to each pedal,
such as damper or sostenuto (page 75). Expression is
not affected by this setting.)
If the effect is an on/off type effect, this setting
specifies the point at which the effect will be
switched on/off.
Setting range:
–2 (effective with the shallowest press) - 0 - +2
(effective with the deepest press)
This specifies the amount of change that can be
produced by the pitch bend function which
smoothly varies the pitch.
This setting applies only to the manually-played
sound.
This setting can be made in semitone steps.
You can set the pedal function (page 75) to spec-
ify whether the pitch will be raised or lowered.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting range:
0–+12 (Pressing the pedal will raise/lower the pitch
by 12 semitones [1 octave])
Normal setting:
–2
Assign the SONG [START/
STOP] function to the pedal
[PedalStart/Stop]
Selecting a type of auxiliary
pedal [AuxPedalType]
TIP
C
A
D
B
Select a pedal to assign
the function.
Set to On or Off.
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
Setting the point at which the
damper pedal starts to affect
the sound [HalfPedalPoint]
Pitch bend range
[PitchBendRange]
C
A
D
B
NO YES
C
A
D
B
NO YES
PF-500 85
Other settings
This setting lets you switch the speaker on/off.
See the procedure on page 63.
Normal (HeadphoneSW)
The speaker will sound only if head-
phones are not connected.
On The speaker will always sound.
Off The speaker will not sound.
You can back up some settings, such as voice selec-
tion and metronome setting, so that they will not
be lost after you turn off the power to the PF-500.
Memory songs (saved in the PF-500’s memory),
the backup on/off setting (this parameter set-
ting), and the “CharacterCode parameter set-
ting (page 47) are always backed up.
See the procedure on page 63.
Setting for:
Transpose, Brilliance, ReverbOnOff, SplitPoint,
Main/LeftVoice, MetronomeSetting, SongSetting,
MidiSetting, and OtherSetting (except for Trans-
pose and SplitPoint setting).
Setting range:
On/Off
Normal setting:
The Transpose, Main/LeftVoice, MetronomeSet-
ting, and OtherSetting (except for Transpose and
SplitPoint setting) parameters are set to Off. Other
parameters are set to On.
You can reset the PF-500 to its normal (factory
default) settings.
The CharacterCode parameter setting in the File
menu does not change.
The MemoryBackUp parameter setting (On/
Off) (left column) is reset to the normal setting.
You can specify whether the memory songs are
erased or kept.
See the procedure on page 63.
Selecting for “MemorySong”:
MemorySongExcluded Memory songs are kept.
MemorySongIncluded Memory songs are
erased.
Press and hold down the white key on the right end
(C7) and press the [POWER] switch to turn on the
power to the PF-500. In this case, the Memory
songs saved in the storage memory are not erased.
If you wish to erase Memory songs at this time,
press and hold down the right-most white key (C7)
and black key (B
6) and press the [POWER] switch
to turn on the power to the PF-500.
Switch the speaker on/off
[Speaker]
Selecting items saved at shut-
down [MemoryBackUp]
C
A
D
B
Select the desired item. Select on or off.
NO YES
Restoring the normal (default)
settings [FactorySet]
Other method for restoring
the normal settings
C
A
D
B
Reset the PF-500.
Select a value for memory songs.
NO YES
[POWER]
C7
B 6
BRIGHTMELLOW
BRILLIANCE
CHORUSREVERB
MIDI
SETTING
OTHER
SETTING
EFFECT
ON OFF
POWER
86 PF-500
Message List
The messages are listed in alphabetical order.
Message Meaning
This will be displayed following the “BulkDataReceiving Voice mes-
sage. This indicates that the PF-500 finished receiving the bulk data.
Once you have verified this message, you may proceed to the next step.
Receiving bulk data has failed. Check the parameter settings and try
again.
The PF-500 is receiving the voice setting bulk data while this mes-
sage is displayed. Wait until the message disappears, then proceed to
the next step.
This message confirms that in the “VoiceBulkDump operation
(page 80), you pressed B [–(NO)] to cancel while data was being
transmitted.
This message is displayed following the message “Executing. The
PF-500’s internal processing is complete. You may proceed to the
next step.
When you attempted to rename a song and save it in “RenameSong”
(page 47), this message will appear if an identically-named song
already exists in the strage memory. Three seconds after this message
is displayed, you will return to the previous screen. Please specify a
different name.
This message prompts you to execute a file-related operation. Press
the B [+ (YES)] button to proceed, or press the [EXIT] button to
cancel.
The PF-500 is processing the data internally. Wait until the message
disappears, then proceed to the next step.
The normal (factory default) settings (except for the memory song
setting) (“FactorySet” on page 85) have been restored. This message
also appears if you press and hold down the C7 key and turn on the
power to the PF-500 (page 85).
The normal (factory default) settings (including the memory song
setting) (“FactorySet” on page 85) have been restored. This message
also appears if you press and hold down the C7 and B
6 keys and
turn on the power to the PF-500 (page 85).
The PF-500’s flash memory (storage memory) has expired. Consult
your Yamaha dealer. If this message appears, the PF-500 will not
back up the songs and settings in memory. Press the [EXIT] button
to return to the previous screen.
PF-500 87
Message List
Message Meaning
There is a problem with the TO HOST/USB connector
When using the PF-500 connected to your personal computer ...
The driver or MIDI application on your computer is not functioning cor-
rectly, perhaps because the computer is turned off, the cable is not con-
nected correctly, or the HOST SELECT switch is not set correctly. In this
case, turn off the power of the PF-500 and your computer, and check the
cable connections and HOST SELECT switch setting. Then turn on the
power in the order of your computer PF-500, and check that the driver
and MIDI application on your computer are functioning correctly.
When using the PF-500 by itself ...
This message may appear if a cable is left connected to the [TO HOST] or
[USB] connector of the PF-500. In this case, turn off the power of the PF-
500, disconnect the cable, and then turn on the power again. If the cable is
left connected, the PF-500 may not function correctly.
You turned off the power to the PF-500 while it was writing a song to
storage memory. This message appears next time you turn on the
power. The PF-500 checks if the contents of storage memory can be
recovered.
This message appears following the message “LastPowerOffIlle-
galMemorySongChecking, indicating that the PF-500 recovered
data in the storage memory as much as possible.
This message appears following the message “LastPowerOffIlle-
galMemorySongChecking, indicating that the PF-500 could not
recover data in the storage memory and that all memory songs were
deleted.
While a preset song was being read, the PF-500 detected defects in
memory. Reset the PF-500 to its normal (factory default) settings
with “MemorySongIncluded” (page 85) after you back up all song
data.
This message indicates that there may be a problem with the mem-
ory. If the message appears repeatedly when you continue using the
PF-500, back up the song data, then restore the default setting by
using “FactorySet” with “MemorySongIncluded” selected (page 85).
There is not enough memory space left and you cannot save any
more songs. Save or delete some songs in the storage memory, then
save new data to memory.
This message will appear if there is no song for the “SaveToMemory”
(page 45) operation to save. In this case, no song will be saved.
You tried to delete a song that does not exist in the storage memory.
You cannot delete the song.
88 PF-500
Message List
Message Meaning
This message prompts you to select whether you wish to overwrite
the existing data with new data when you add recordings to a
song. Press the B [+ (YES)] button to allow overwriting. Press the
B
[– (NO)] button to cancel.
You tried to start playing a song or perform another operation right
after you select the song. Wait until the message disappears.
You tried to copy or delete data in internally-protected files (such as
commercially available music data). You cannot write to, copy, or
delete such files.
After you load an internally-protected song such as commercially
available music data into the PF-500’s Current memory or storage
memory, you tried to save the song to a personal computer. You can-
not save such a song to a personal computer etc.
This message prompts you to select whether you wish to save the
edited settings. Press the B [+ (YES)] button to save the settings.
Press the [EXIT] button to cancel.
You tried to perform another operation before saving the recorded
song to storage memory. If you continue the operation, the recorded
song will be lost. To delete the new recording, press the B [– (NO)]
button. To keep the recording, press the B [+ (YES)] button. The PF-
500 displays the “SaveToMemory” (page 45) parameter screen. Save
the recorded song, then proceed to another operation.
1. This message will appear if a problem is found with the song data
when you select a song or while the song is playing. In this case, re-
select the song, and try once again to play it back. If the message
still appears, the song data may have been damaged.
2. This message will appear if a different “CharacterCode (page 47)
is selected than when you assigned the song name. In this case,
switch the “CharacterCode, re-select the song, and play back.
PF-500 89
Message List
Message Meaning
1. This message will be displayed if current memory fills up during
recording. Recording will stop automatically at this point. The
data that had been recorded up to that point will remain. This
message will also be displayed when you attempt to enter Record
mode for additional recording if that song already occupies all of
current memory. In this case, additional recording will not be pos-
sible. If there is an already-recorded track that you do not need to
keep, you can use “ChannelClear” (page 66) to delete the
unneeded track, so that you will then be able to record the equiva-
lent amount of additional material.
2. This message will be displayed when you select a song if that song
is larger than the capacity of the current memory (page 90). This
song cannot be loaded into the PF-500, and cannot be played back.
Please select a different song.
This message will be displayed when you edit a song if that song is
larger than the capacity of the current memory (page 90). This song
cannot be edited on the PF-500.
This message prompts you to start the operation. To start, press the
B [+ (YES)] button. Press the [EXIT] button to cancel the operation.
This message prompts you to confirm the execution. Press the
B
[+ (YES)] button to continue. Press the B [– (NO)] button to can-
cel.
This message means that the PF-500 was unable to transmit voice
bulk data. If this message appears, make sure that the power of your
computer is not turned off, that the cable is connected correctly, that
the HOST SELECT switch is set correctly, and that the driver on
your computer is functioning correctly. Then try transmitting the
data once again.
You used a period or space at the beginning of a song name or you
tried to change a song name that includes a character (or characters)
not supported by the PF-500, and the PF-500 could not process the
name. The PF-500 displays the previous screen in three seconds.
Rename the song correctly.
90 PF-500
Questions about Operations
and Functions
The buttons do not respond.
While you are using a function, some buttons
not used for the function are disabled. If the
song is playing, stop the playback. Otherwise,
press the [EXIT] button to return to the main
screen. Then, perform the desired operation.
The sound sustains and does not decay
when I press the sostenuto pedal.
With the voices in the CHURCH ORGAN,
JAZZ ORGAN, STRINGS, or CHOIR group,
and some voices of [XG] group the sound con-
tinues sustaining while you are holding down
the sostenuto pedal.
Higher or lower notes does not sound cor-
rectly when the transpose or octave setting
is made.
The setting range for the transposition and
octave setting is C-2 - G8. (With the normal set-
ting, the PF-500’s 88 keys covers the range of A-
1 - C7.) If the lowest key is set to a note lower
than C-2, it will produce a sound one octave
higher. If the highest key is set to a note higher
than G8, it will produce a sound one octave
lower.
How can I return to the recording or song
select screen during song recording or play-
back?
Press one of the SONG SELECT [ ] and
[ ] buttons once.
The tempo does not change even though I
recorded with tempo changes.
Depending on the timing of tempo changes, the
changed tempo may not be recorded. In this
case, the recording will be played back at the
original tempo.
Make tempo changes when the recording track
is selected and a red track indicator is flashing.
The same trick applies to editing the tempo
after recording.
Performance in Dual or Split mode is not
recorded.
Track data is lost unexpectedly.
For Dual or Split mode recording, the recording
track for the second voice (that is, the voice for
the left-hand part) is automatically assigned
(page 30). Therefore, if the track already has
data, the data will be overwritten during
recording. Also, switching to Dual mode or
Split mode in the middle of the song is not
recorded. Therefore, the notes you played with
the second voice (or the notes lower than the
Split point) are not recorded.
What type of data is recorded?
Data recorded in the tracks:
Note data (notes you play)
Voice selection
PF-500 pedals and external pedal on/off
Reverb depth [ReverbSend]
Chorus depth [ChorusSend]
DSP effect depth [DSPDepth]
Sound brightness [Brightness]
Resonance effect setting [Harmonic Content]
Equalizer’s low-range frequency setting
[EQ LowFreq.]
Equalizer’s low-range gain setting [EQ LowGain]
Equalizer’s high-range frequency setting
[EQ HighFreq.]
Equalizer’s high-range gain setting
[EQ HighGain]
Octave setting of the voice [Octave]
Volume setting of each voice [Volume]
Left/right position of each sound [Pan]
Fine pitch adjustment between two voices
(Dual only) [Detune]
Volume change in response to playing
strength for each voice [TouchSense]
Data recorded globally in all tracks:
•Tempo
Time signature
•Reverb type
Chorus type
DSP effect type
You can change all data except for note data after
recording.
You can change the time signature at the beginning of
the song, or at a position in the song to which you
move, by using the B [–]/[+] buttons while the song
is stopped.
PF-500 91
Questions about Operations and Functions
I cannot change the key signature in the
song after recording.
Press the [TOP] button to locate the top of the
song, use the B [–]/[+] buttons to locate the
measure in which you wish to change the key
signature, then change it.
How much data can I record?
Current memory (page 45): About 800KB
Storage memory (page 45): About 750KB
The on/off setting of the pedal connected to
the AUX PEDAL jack is reversed.
Some types of pedals may turn on and off in
opposite fashion. Use the AuxPedalType”
parameter (page 76) in the “OTHER SET-
TING” menu to change the external pedal set-
ting.
The song title is not correct.
The “CharacterCode setting may be different
than that used when you named the song. Also,
if the song was recorded on another instru-
ment, the title might be displayed incorrectly.
Use the “CharacterCode parameter (page 47)
in the FILE menu to change the setting. How-
ever, if the song was recorded on another
instrument, changing the “CharacterCode
parameter setting may not resolve the problem.
What is the difference between “Touch-
Sense” and “TouchResponse” MIDI data?
“TouchSense” determines the manner and
degree to which the volume level changes in
response to your touch on the keyboard. The
MIDI note-on velocity data is not changed. It
changes the volume level at the same velocity
data.
“TouchResponse determines the touch sensi-
tivity of an instrument. The MIDI note-on
velocity data is changed when you play the key-
board with a consistent touch.
92 PF-500
MEMO
PF-500 93
Appendix
94 PF-500
Troubleshooting
Problem Cause Solution
The power of the PF-500 does not
turn on.
The power cable is not plugged in
(check at the PF-500 and at the
electrical outlet).
Insert the power cable plug rmly
into the PF-500 and into the electri-
cal outlet of the correct voltage.
(page 15)
There is a clicking noise when you
press [POWER] to turn the power
on or off.
This is caused by the electrical
power within the instrument.
This is not a malfunction.
Noise is heard from the PF-500.
A portable telephone is being used
near the PF-500 (or the ring tone is
sounding).
Turn off the power of the portable
telephone located near the PF-500.
Noise may be heard if a portable
telephone is used near the PF-500
or if the ring tone occurs.
The overall volume is too low. Or,
there is no sound at all.
The [MASTER VOLUME] is low-
ered.
Raise [MASTER VOLUME].
(page 16)
Headphones are connected (only if
the Speaker setting is Normal
HeadphoneSW). (page 85)
Disconnect the headphone plug.
Speaker setting is off.
Set [Speaker] to Normal or ON.
(page 85)
Local Control is turned off. Set Local control ON. (page 79)
Expression is assigned to one of
the right, center, and left pedals.
Assign any function other than
Expression to the pedal.
The keyboard volume is lower than
the song playback volume.
The volume level for the keyboard
performance is set too low.
Move [SONG BALANCE] toward
the keyboard to increase the key-
board volume.
Sound is still heard from the speak-
ers even though headphones are
plugged in.
Speaker setting is On.
Set the speaker setting to Normal
(HeadphoneSW). (page 85)
Damper pedal does not function, or
notes are sustained even though
the damper pedal is not pressed.
The plug of the pedal unit is not
inserted into the [PEDAL] jack.
Insert the plug rmly into the
[PEDAL] jack. (page 14)
PF-500 95
Data Compatibility
This section covers basic information on data compatibility: whether or not other MIDI devices can playback the
data recorded by PF-500, and whether or not the PF-500 can playback commercially available song data or song data
created for other instruments or on a computer.
Depending on the MIDI device or data characteristics, you may be able to play back the data without any problem,
or you may have to perform some special operations before the data can be played back. If you run into problems
playing back data, please refer to the information below.
Basic Check Points
The data and the MIDI device must match in regards
to the items below.
Sequence format
Voice allocation format
Sequence Format
The system which records song data is called “sequence
format.
Playback is only possible when the sequence format
of the disk matches that of the MIDI device.
[Common Sequence Formats]
SMF (Standard MIDI File)
This is the most common sequence format.
Standard MIDI Files are generally available as one
of two types: Format 0 or Format 1.
Many MIDI devices are compatible with Format
0, and most commercially available software is
recorded as Format 0.
The PF-500 is compatible with both Format 0 and
Format 1.
Performance data recorded on the PF-500 is saved
in the SMF format 0 in a floppy disk.
ESEQ
This sequence format is compatible with many of
Yamahas MIDI devices, including the PF-500 series
instruments. This is a common format used with
various Yamaha software.
The PF-500 is compatible with ESEQ.
96 PF-500
Data Compatibility
Voice Allocation Format
With MIDI, voices are assigned to specific numbers,
called “program numbers. The numbering standard
(order of voice allocation) is referred to as the “voice
allocation format.
Voices may not play back as expected unless the
voice allocation format of the song data matches
that of the compatible MIDI device used for play-
back.
[Main Voice Allocation Formats]
GM System Level 1
This is one of the most common voice allocation
formats.
Many MIDI devices are compatible with GM Sys-
tem Level 1, as is most commercially available
software.
The PF-500 is compatible with GM System Level
1.
XG
XG is a major enhancement of the GM System Level
1 format, and was developed by Yamaha specifically
to provide more voices and variations, as well as
greater expressive control over voices and effects,
and to ensure compatibility of data well into the
future.
The PF-500 is compatible with XG.
Performance data recorded with preset voices on
the PF-500 can be played on other XG-compati-
ble instruments.
DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection)
This voice allocation format is compatible with
many of Yamahas MIDI devices, including the PF-
500 series instruments.
This is also common format used with various
Yamaha software.
The PF-500 is compatible with DOC.
Even if the devices and data used satisfy all the
conditions above, the data may still not be com-
pletely compatible, depending on the specifica-
tions of the devices and particular data recording
methods.
PF-500 97
Preset Voice List
: YES, ×: No
Voice
group
Voice name
Stereo
sampling
Touch
Sense
Dynamic
sampling
Key-off
samples
String
resonance
Voice description
GRAND
PIANO1
GrandPiano1
This sound was sampled from a full concert grand
piano. Three stages of dynamics were sampled,
and no effort has been spared in making the sound
virtually identical to that of an acoustic piano. Even
the tonal changes produced by the damper pedal
and the subtle sounds of releasing a key are repro-
duced. The sympathetic vibration (string reso-
nance) that occurs between the strings of an
acoustic piano has also been simulated. Suitable
not only for classical compositions but also for piano
pieces of any style.
MellowPiano
A warm and mellow piano sound. Ideal for classical
music.
RockPiano
A bright-sounding piano. Ideal for rock styles.
HonkyTonk
Piano
×
A honky-tonk style piano. Enjoy a tonal character
that is quite different than a grand piano.
GRAND
PIANO2
GrandPiano2
×××
A spacious and clear piano sound with a bright res-
onance. Ideal for popular music.
BrightPiano
×××
A spacious and bright piano sound. Ideal for popu-
lar and rock music.
E.PIANO1
E.Piano1
×××
An electronic piano sound produced by an FM syn-
thesizer. The tone will change as you vary your
playing touch. Ideal for popular music.
SynthPiano
× ×××
This voice simulates the electric piano sound pro-
duced by synthesizers in popular music. It also
goes well with the acoustic piano sound.
E.PIANO2
E.Piano2
××
The sound of an electric piano using hammer-
struck metallic tines. Soft tone when played lightly,
and an aggressive tone when played hard.
Vintage
E.Piano
×××
A different type of electric piano sound. Widely used
in rock and popular music.
HARPSI
CHORD
Harpsichord
8'
×× ×
The sound of the instrument frequently used in
baroque music. Variations in playing touch will not
affect the volume, and a characteristic sound will be
heard when you release the key.
Harpsichord
8'+4'
×× ×
A harpsichord with an added upper octave. Pro-
duces a more brilliant sound.
E.CLAVI
CHORD
E.Clavichord
×××
This is the voice of a keyboard that produces sound
by striking the strings with magnetic pickups. This
funky sound is popular in black contemporary music.
Because of its unique structure, the instrument pro-
duces a peculiar sound when you release the keys.
Wah Clavi.
×××
A distinctive effect is preset.
VIBRA-
PHONE
Vibraphone
××
Vibraphone played with relatively soft mallets. The
tone becomes more metallic the harder you play.
Marimba
×××
A marimba sound, sampled in stereo for spacious-
ness and realism.
Celesta
××
The sound of a celesta (a percussion instrument in
which hammers strike metallic bars to produce
sound). This instrument is well-known for its
appearance in Dance of the Sugar-plum Fairies
from Tchaikovskys Nutcracker Suite.
98 PF-500
Preset Voice List
Voice group Voice name
Stereo
sampling
Touch
Sense
Dynamic
sampling
Key-off
samples
String
resonance
Voice description
GUITAR
NylonGuitar
× ×××
A warm and natural nylon-string guitar sound.
Enjoy the atmosphere it adds to a quiet song.
SteelGuitar
× ×××
A bright steel guitar sound. Ideal for popular
music.
CHURCH
ORGAN
PipeOrgan
Principal
××××
This voice features the combination of pipes
(8'+4'+2') of a principal (brass instrument)
organ. It is suitable for Baroque church music.
PipeOrgan
Tutti
××××
This voice features a full coupler of a pipe
organ, famous for the sound used in Toccatta
and Fugue by Bach.
PipeOrgan
Flute1
××××
A pipe organ sound that combines ute-type
(woodwind type) stops of different pitches (8'
+ 4'). This is a gentle sound that is ideal for
accompanying hymns.
PipeOrgan
Flute2
××××
A pipe organ sound that combines ute-type
(woodwind type) stops of different pitches (8'
+ 4' + 1-1/3'). This is brighter than
PipeOrganFlute1, and is suitable for solos.
JAZZORGAN
JazzOrgan
×××××
The sound of a tonewheel type electric
organ. Often heard in jazz and rock idioms.
RotaryOrgan
×××××
A bright electric organ sound.
MellowOrgan
×××××
A mellow electric organ sound. Ideal for
calmer songs.
STRINGS
Strings
×××
Stereo-sampled, large-scale strings ensemble
with realistic reverb. Try combining this voice
with piano in the Dual mode.
SynthStrings
× ×××
A bright and spacious strings sound. Suitable
for sustained parts in the background of an
ensemble.
SlowStrings
×××
The sound of a string ensemble, with a slow
attack. Suitable for use in Dual mode with
GRAND PIANO or E.PIANO.
CHOIR
Choir
× ×××
A big, spacious choir voice. Perfect for creat-
ing rich harmonies in slow pieces.
SlowChoir
× ×××
The sound of a choir with a slow attack. Suit-
able for use in Dual mode with GRAND
PIANO or E.PIANO.
Scat
×××
You can enjoy jazz scatting with this voice.
Depending on how hard and what note range
you play, different sounds will be produced.
SYNTH.PAD
SynthPad1
× ×××
A warm, mellow, and spacious synth sound.
Ideal for sustained parts in the background of
an ensemble.
SynthPad2
× ×××
A clear and spacious synth sound. Ideal for
sustained parts in the background of an
ensemble.
WOOD BASS
WoodBass
× ×××
The sound of a nger-plucked upright bass.
Frequently used in jazz and Latin music.
Bass&Cymbal
× ×××
The sound of a cymbal has been layered onto
the bass. Effective when used for jazz walk-
ing-bass lines.
E.BASS
ElectricBass
× ×××
The sound of an electric bass. Frequently
used in jazz, rock, and popular music.
FretlessBass
× ×××
The sound of a fretless bass. Suitable for
styles such as jazz and fusion.
PF-500 99
Voice Combination Examples
(Dual and Split)
Dual
Split
Dual + Split
MAIN + MAIN
GrandPiano1 + E.Piano1
GrandPiano1 + E.Piano2
This combination is often used in popular music.
MAIN + MAIN GrandPiano1 + SynthPiano This produces a fantasy, spacious piano sound.
MAIN + MAIN GrandPiano2 + GrandPiano2
This combination sounds as if you are playing
two notes that are one octave apart. It is suitable
for the accompaniment of Salsa music.
MAIN + MAIN E.Piano1 + SlowChoir This is suitable for romantic ballads.
MAIN + MAIN E.Piano2 + E.Clavichord
This is suitable for funk, rhythm & blues, and soul
music.
MAIN + MAIN Harpsichord8' + Strings
This combination is very suitable for Baroque
music.
MAIN + MAIN Celesta + SynthStirngs
This combination adds strings and bell sound. A
delay effect is automatically applied.
MAIN / LEFT
GrandPiano1 / WoodBass
or Bass&Cymbal
This is recommended for light Jazz music. The
damper pedal is effective on the voice assigned
to the right-hand range.
MAIN / LEFT Celesta / Choir
This is suitable for a peaceful, somewhat cute
song.
MAIN / LEFT Choir / GrandPiano1
Play these voices elegantly along with piano
arpeggio. Playing the Choir voice in chords
would be more effective.
MAIN / LEFT Scat / WoodBass
This combination features a cool (stylish) jazz
chorus. The Scat voice is touch sensitive, adding
a variety of expressions.
MAIN / LEFT E.Piano2 / Scat
Playing the Scat voice for a bass part may create
an interesting sound.
MAIN + MAIN / LEFT
GrandPiano1 + SynthString /
GrandPiano1
This combination creates the thick sound of a
layered piano and strings.
MAIN + MAIN / LEFT
GrandPiano2 + E.Piano1 /
ElectricBass
This sound is suitable for fusion. Deeper reverb
and chorus (page 71) will improve the groove.
The damper pedal is effective on the voice
assigned to the right-hand range.
MAIN + MAIN / LEFT + LEFT
Harpsichord8' + 4' + Strings /
Harpsichord8' + Strings
This combination makes a very brilliant sound.
100 PF-500
Assembling the Keyboard Stand
You can use the PF-500 without installing the stand.
However, if you wish to attach the stand to the PF-500,
follow the steps below.
CAUTION
Be careful not to confuse parts. Make sure that you
install all parts in the correct orientation. Assemble
the stand in accordance with the steps below.
At least two persons should assemble the stand
together.
Be sure to use the correct-size screws, as indicated
below. Use of incorrect screws can cause damages to
the stand.
When you attach each part, be sure to tighten all
screws.
Reverse the assembly procedure to disassemble the
stand.
Keyboard
Remove the following parts from the package.
Screws
1.
Attaching the front legs to the stand.
2. Attaching the rear legs to the stand.
3. Attaching the plate.
Use the included wrench.
Plate
Stand
Front left leg Front right leg
Rear left leg Rear right leg
Pedal unit
AC power cord
Long screws (6x65mm) x 8
Short screws (6x20mm) x 8
Cap bolts x 4
Cord holders x 2
Wrench x 1
2
3
1 Place the stand on the oor so
that the bottom side (with
smaller holes) faces up.
4 Attach the front left leg in the same way.
2 Use a short screw to
attach the bracket of the
front right leg to the bot-
tom side of the stand.
3 Use two long screws to
x the bracket of the
front right leg to the front
side of the stand.
1
2
1 Use a short screw to
attach the bracket of the
rear left leg to the bottom
side of the stand.
2 Use two long screws to x
the bracket of the rear left
leg to the rear side of the
stand.
3 Attach the rear right leg
in the same way.
Align the holes on the plate
with the holes of the rear
side of the bracket on the
rear legs, then x them
using four short screws.
PF-500 101
Assembling the Keyboard Stand
4. Raising the stand to the standing
position.
5. Mounting the keyboard.
6. Fixing the keyboard.
7. Connecting the pedal unit.
8. Set the voltage selector and connect
the power cord to the AC INLET on
the keyboard.
Voltage Selector
Before connecting the AC power cord, check the setting of the volt-
age selector (provided in some locations). To set the selector for
110V, 130V, 220V or 240V main voltages, use a "minus" screwdriver
to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for your region
appears next to the pointer on the panel. The voltage selector is set
at 240V when the unit is initially shipped.
After the proper voltage has been selected, connect the AC power
cord to the AC INLET and an AC wall outlet. A plug adaptor may
also be provided in some areas to match the pin configuration of
the AC wall outlets in your area.
WARNING
An improper voltage setting can cause serious damage to the PF-
500 or result in improper operation.
After completing the assembly, please check the
following.
Are any parts left over?
Review the assembly procedure and correct any errors.
Is the PF-500 clear of doors and other movable fixtures?
Move the PF-500 to an appropriate location.
Does the PF-500 make a rattling noise when you shake it?
Tighten all screws.
Are the pedal and power cords inserted securely into the
sockets?
Check the connections.
If the keyboard stand creaks or is otherwise unsteady
when you play the keyboard, refer to the assembly dia-
grams and retighten all screws.
CAUTION
Be careful not to pinch your fingers.
CAUTION
Be careful not to pinch your fingers or drop the key-
board.
CAUTION
Do not hold any part of the keyboard other than
four corners as shown in the illustration.
Use the front legs as
support to raise the
stand.
Be sure to hold the four corners of the
keyboard.
Mount the keyboard so that the rubber
feet on the bottom of the keyboard fall
into the holes on the stand.
Attach the cap bolts on the
bottom of the stand and
tighten them with your hand
to x the keyboard.
PE
DAL
2
3
2 Connect the pedal cord plug
into the PEDAL jack on the
left side of the keyboard,
with the arrow on the plug
facing up.
3 Attach the cord holders in the position shown in the
illustration, and clip the pedal cord to the holders.
* You can also clip the power cord to the cord holders.
1 Place the pedal unit in front of the rear legs.
AC INLE
T
VOLTAGE SELECTOR
102 PF-500
Index
You can search the desired section using not only the terminology in this manual but also commonly-used words.
The * mark indicates that the corresponding page includes the terminology explanation in the right column.
Numerics
50 Piano Preset Songs 22
Practicing a one-hand part 24
A
Adding variation to the sound
Effect function 28
Assembly 100
Assigning the START/STOP function
to a pedal 84
AUX IN jacks 51
AUX OUT jacks 52
AUX PEDAL jacks 52
Auxiliary pedal function 76
B
BackUp 85
Bench 11
BRILLIANCE 28
C
Center pedal 27
Center pedal function 75
Character Code 47
Characters 47
CHORUS 29
combining two voices
Dual mode 30
Connection
Audio 52
computer 53
MIDI 56
Other Components 51
Serial 54
Speaker 51
USB 57
Connectors
MIDI IN/OUT/THRU 52, 56
CONTRAST* 16
D
Damper (right) pedal 27
Data Compatibility 95
Data type 50
Default (Normal) setting* 28
Demonstration tunes 20
Detailed Settings 60
Metronome 68
MIDI 77
Other settings 81
recording and playback 65
voices 69
Display contrast 16
DOWN (TEMPO)
50 Piano Preset Songs 23
metronome 34
Dual
Detailed settings 69
Recording 42
Dual mode
combining two voices 30
E
Effect function 28
equalizer 74
EXIT 19
EXTRA TRACKS
the third or more tracks 40
F
FactorySet 85
Fast forward 23, 49
FILE* 43
H
Headphones 16
HOST SELECT switch 52
J
Jacks
AUX IN 51
AUX OUT 52
AUX PEDAL 52
PHONES 16
TO HOST 52, 54
USB 52
K
Keyboard stand (assembly) 100
L
LCD Screen 19
Contrast 16
Left pedal 27
Left pedal function 76
List
Demonstration tunes 20
Detailed Settings 60
Message 86
Preset Voice 97
M
MASTER VOLUME* 16
Memory 43
Memory song 43
MemoryBackUp 85
Message List 86
Metronome 34
Detailed settings 68
METRONOME SETTING 68
MIDI 77
Detailed settings 77
MIDI cables 56
MIDI connectors 53, 56
MIDI driver 54
MIDI SETTING 77
Music stand 14
N
New Song 35
Normal setting* 28
O
Other settings 81
P
Pedal Function
Auxiliary 76
Center 75
Left 76
Right 75
Pedal unit 14
Pedals 27
Index
PF-500 103
Personal computer 53
PHONES jacks 16
Playback
50 Piano Preset Songs 22
Demo Songs 21
Recorded Songs 49
Playing back repeatedly (song) 67
Playing back repeatedly
(specifying the range) 66
playing two voices Split mode 32
POWER 15
Practicing a one-hand part
(50 preset songs) 24
Preset song memory 43
Preset Voice List 97
R
Recording
Tape Recorder 52
Recording in Dual 42
Recording in Split 42
Recording Your Performance 35
Re-recording 37
REVERB 29
Rewind 23, 49
Right pedal 27
Right pedal function 75
S
Scale 82
Screen 19
Select
50 piano preset songs 22
Demo Songs 21
Recorded Songs 48
Selecting a touch response 81
SETTING
metronome 68
Volume 16
SMF (Standard MIDI File) 95
Soft (left) pedal 27
Song
Data Type 50
Delete 46
Detailed settings 65
Playing back repeatedly 67
Rename 47
Store 43
SONG [START/STOP]
50 Piano Preset Songs 22
Recorded Songs 49
Recording 36
SONG BALANCE 42
SONG SELECT
50 Piano Preset Songs 22
Recorded Songs 48
Recording 35
SONG SETTING 65
Sostenuto (center) pedal 27
Sound
brilliance 28
expression 28
reverberation 29
spread and spaciousness 29
Soundboard reverb 29
Split
Detailed settings 69
Recording 42
Split mode playing two voices 32
Split point 33
Splitting the keyboard range and playing
two different voices 32
START/STOP
metronome 34
Storage memory 43
StringResonance 83
SustainSampling 83
Synchro Start
50 preset songs 24
Recorded Songs 49
T
TEMPO
50 Piano Preset Songs 23
metronome 34
Recorded Songs 49
the third or more tracks EXTRA
TRACKS 40
TO HOST jack 52, 54
TOP
50 Piano Preset Songs 23
Recorded Songs 49
Recording 36
TouchResponse 81
Track playback on and off 50
TRACK1/TRACK2
50 Piano Preset Songs 24
Recording 35, 39
Troubleshooting 94
Tune 81
Type of characters 47
Type of data (recorded) 90
U
UP (TEMPO)
50 Piano Preset Songs 23
metronome 34
USB jack 52
V
Voice group buttons 26, 32
VOICE SETTING 69
Voices* 26
Detailed settings 69
Volume
Balance (SONG BLANCE) 42
Setting 16
X
XG 96
104 PF-500
MEMO
PF-500 105
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
INFORMATION RELATING TO PERSONAL INJURY, ELECTRICAL SHOCK,
AND FIRE HAZARD POSSIBILITIES HAS BEEN INCLUDED IN THIS LIST.
WARNING- When using any electrical or electronic product,
basic precautions should always be followed. These precautions
include, but are not limited to, the following:
1. Read all Safety Instructions, Installation Instructions, Spe-
cial Message Section items, and any Assembly Instructions
found in this manual BEFORE making any connections, includ-
ing connection to the main supply.
2. Main Power Supply Verification: Yamaha products are
manufactured specifically for the supply voltage in the area
where they are to be sold. If you should move, or if any doubt
exists about the supply voltage in your area, please contact your
dealer for supply voltage verification and (if applicable) instruc-
tions. The required supply voltage is printed on the name plate.
For name plate location, please refer to the graphic found in the
Special Message Section of this manual.
3. This product may be equipped with a polarized plug (one
blade wider than the other). If you are unable to insert the plug
into the outlet, turn the plug over and try again. If the problem
persists, contact an electrician to have the obsolete outlet
replaced. Do NOT defeat the safety purpose of the plug.
4. Some electronic products utilize external power supplies
or adapters. Do NOT connect this type of product to any power
supply or adapter other than one described in the owners manual,
on the name plate, or specifically recommended by Yamaha.
5. WARNING: Do not place this product or any other
objects on the power cord or place it in a position where anyone
could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over power or connect-
ing cords of any kind. The use of an extension cord is not recom-
mended! If you must use an extension cord, the minimum wire
size for a 25’ cord (or less) is 18 AWG. NOTE: The smaller the
AWG number, the larger the current handling capacity. For
longer extension cords, consult a local electrician.
6. Ventilation: Electronic products, unless specifically
designed for enclosed installations, should be placed in locations
that do not interfere with proper ventilation. If instructions for
enclosed installations are not provided, it must be assumed that
unobstructed ventilation is required.
7. Temperature considerations: Electronic products should
be installed in locations that do not significantly contribute to
their operating temperature. Placement of this product close to
heat sources such as; radiators, heat registers and other devices
that produce heat should be avoided.
8. This product was NOT designed for use in wet/damp loca-
tions and should not be used near water or exposed to rain.
Examples of wet/damp locations are; near a swimming pool, spa,
tub, sink, or wet basement.
9. This product should be used only with the components
supplied or; a cart, rack, or stand that is recommended by the
manufacturer. If a cart, rack, or stand is used, please observe all
safety markings and instructions that accompany the accessory
product.
10. The power supply cord (plug) should be disconnected
from the outlet when electronic products are to be left unused for
extended periods of time. Cords should also be disconnected
when there is a high probability of lightning and/or electrical
storm activity.
11. Care should be taken that objects do not fall and liquids are
not spilled into the enclosure through any openings that may exist.
12. Electrical/electronic products should be serviced by a
qualified service person when:
a. The power supply cord has been damaged; or
b. Objects have fallen, been inserted, or liquids have been
spilled into the enclosure through openings; or
c. The product has been exposed to rain: or
d. The product dose not operate, exhibits a marked change
in performance; or
e. The product has been dropped, or the enclosure of the
product has been damaged.
13. Do not attempt to service this product beyond that
described in the user-maintenance instructions. All other servic-
ing should be referred to qualified service personnel.
14. This product, either alone or in combination with an
amplifier and headphones or speaker/s, may be capable of pro-
ducing sound levels that could cause permanent hearing loss. DO
NOT operate for a long period of time at a high volume level or
at a level that is uncomfortable. If you experience any hearing
loss or ringing in the ears, you should consult an audiologist.
IMPORTANT: The louder the sound, the shorter the time period
before damage occurs.
15. Some Yamaha products may have benches and/or accessory
mounting fixtures that are either supplied as a part of the product
or as optional accessories. Some of these items are designed to be
dealer assembled or installed. Please make sure that benches are
stable and any optional fixtures (where applicable) are well
secured BEFORE using. Benches supplied by Yamaha are
designed for seating only. No other uses are recommended.
PLEASE KEEP THIS MANUAL
92-469-2
106 PF-500
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA. (class B)
(2 wires)
This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha-Kemble Music
(U.K.) Ltd.
(polarity)
This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha Canada Music
Ltd.
Ceci ne sapplique quaux produits distribués par Yamaha Canada
Musique Ltée.
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT!
This product, when installed as indicated in the instruc-
tions contained in this manual, meets FCC require-
ments. Modications not expressly approved by
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to
use the product.
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to acces-
sories and/or another product use only high quality
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product
MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Fail-
ure to follow instructions could void your FCC authori-
zation to use this product in the USA.
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to com-
ply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations,
Part 15 for Class B digital devices. Compliance with
these requirements provides a reasonable level of
assurance that your use of this product in a residential
environment will not result in harmful interference with
other electronic devices. This equipment generates/
uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used
according to the instructions found in the users manual,
may cause interference harmful to the operation of
other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regula-
tions does not guarantee that interference will not occur
in all installations. If this product is found to be the
source of interference, which can be determined by
turning the unit OFF and ON, please try to eliminate
the problem by using one of the following measures:
Relocate either this product or the device that is being
affected by the interference.
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line lter/s.
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon
lead, change the lead-in to co-axial type cable.
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfac-
tory results, please contact the local retailer authorized
to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate
the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corpo-
ration of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600
Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA90620
The above statements apply ONLY to those products
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its
subsidiaries.
IMPORTANT NOTICE FOR THE UNITED KINGDOM
Connecting the Plug and Cord
IMPORTANT. The wires in this mains lead are coloured in
accordance with the following code:
BLUE : NEUTRAL
BROWN : LIVE
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this appa-
ratus may not correspond with the coloured makings iden-
tifying the terminals in your plug proceed as follows:
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to
the terminal which is marked with the letter N or coloured
BLACK.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to
the terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured
RED.
Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth ter-
minal of the three pin plug.
CAUTION: TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH
WIDE BLADE OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.
ATTENTION: POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS ÉLEC-
TRIQUES, INTRODUIRE LA LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE
LA FICHE DANS LA BORNE CORRESPONDANTE DE LA
PRISE ET POUSSER JUSQU’AU FOND.
PF-500 107
For details of products, please contact your nearest Yamaha or the
authorized distributor listed below.
Pour plus de détails sur les produits, veuillez-vous adresser à Yamaha ou
au distributeur le plus proche de vous figurant dans la liste suivante.
Die Einzelheiten zu Produkten sind bei Ihrer unten aufgeführten
Niederlassung und bei Yamaha Vertragshändlern in den jeweiligen
Bestimmungsländern erhältlich.
Para detalles sobre productos, contacte su tienda Yamaha más cercana
o el distribuidor autorizado que se lista debajo.
CANADA
Yamaha Canada Music Ltd.
135 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario,
M1S 3R1, Canada
Tel: 416-298-1311
U.S.A.
Yamaha Corporation of America
6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620,
U.S.A.
Tel: 714-522-9011
MEXICO
Yamaha de Mexico S.A. De C.V.,
Departamento de ventas
Javier Rojo Gomez No.1149, Col. Gpe Del
Moral, Deleg. Iztapalapa, 09300 Mexico, D.F.
Tel: 686-00-33
BRAZIL
Yamaha Musical do Brasil LTDA.
Av. Rebouças 2636, São Paulo, Brasil
Tel: 011-853-1377
ARGENTINA
Yamaha de Panamá S.A. Sucursal de Argentina
Viamonte 1145 Piso2-B 1053,
Buenos Aires, Argentina
Tel: 1-4371-7021
PANAMA AND OTHER LATIN
AMERICAN COUNTRIES/
CARIBBEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha de Panamá S.A.
Torre Banco General, Piso 7, Urbanización Marbella,
Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia,
Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá
Tel: 507-269-5311
THE UNITED KINGDOM
Yamaha-Kemble Music (U.K.) Ltd.
Sherbourne Drive, Tilbrook, Milton Keynes,
MK7 8BL, England
Tel: 01908-366700
IRELAND
Danfay Ltd.
61D, Sallynoggin Road, Dun Laoghaire, Co. Dublin
Tel: 01-2859177
GERMANY/SWITZERLAND
Yamaha Europa GmbH.
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen,
F.R. of Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
AUSTRIA
Yamaha Music Austria
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien Austria
Tel: 01-60203900
THE NETHERLANDS
Yamaha Music Nederland
Kanaalweg 18G, 3526KL, Utrecht, The Netherlands
Tel: 030-2828411
BELGIUM
Yamaha Music Belgium
Keiberg Imperiastraat 8, 1930 Zaventem, Belgium
Tel: 02-7258220
FRANCE
Yamaha Musique France,
Division Professionnelle
BP 70-77312 Marne-la-Vallée Cedex 2, France
Tel: 01-64-61-4000
ITALY
Yamaha Musica Italia S.P.A.,
Combo Division
Viale Italia 88, 20020 Lainate (Milano), Italy
Tel: 02-935-771
SPAIN/PORTUGAL
Yamaha-Hazen Electronica Musical, S.A.
Ctra. de la Coruna km. 17, 200, 28230
Las Rozas (Madrid) Spain
Tel: 91-201-0700
GREECE
Philippe Nakas S.A.
Navarinou Street 13, P.Code 10680, Athens, Greece
Tel: 01-364-7111
SWEDEN
Yamaha Scandinavia AB
J. A. Wettergrens Gata 1
Box 30053
S-400 43 Göteborg, Sweden
Tel: 031 89 34 00
DENMARK
YS Copenhagen Liaison Office
Generatorvej 8B
DK-2730 Herlev, Denmark
Tel: 44 92 49 00
FINLAND
F-Musiikki Oy
Kluuvikatu 6, P.O. Box 260,
SF-00101 Helsinki, Finland
Tel: 09 618511
NORWAY
Norsk filial av Yamaha Scandinavia AB
Grini Næringspark 1
N-1345 Østerås, Norway
Tel: 67 16 77 70
ICELAND
Skifan HF
Skeifan 17 P.O. Box 8120
IS-128 Reykjavik, Iceland
Tel: 525 5000
OTHER EUROPEAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Europa GmbH.
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen,
F.R. of Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: 053-460-2312
TURKEY/CYPRUS
Yamaha Europa GmbH.
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen,
F.R. of Germany
Tel: 04101-3030
OTHER COUNTRIES
Yamaha Music Gulf FZE
LB21-128 Jebel Ali Freezone
P.O.Box 17328, Dubai, U.A.E.
Tel: 971-4-881-5868
HONG KONG
Tom Lee Music Co., Ltd.
11/F., Silvercord Tower 1, 30 Canton Road,
Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong
Tel: 2737-7688
INDONESIA
PT. Yamaha Music Indonesia (Distributor)
PT. Nusantik
Gedung Yamaha Music Center, Jalan Jend. Gatot
Subroto Kav. 4, Jakarta 12930, Indonesia
Tel: 21-520-2577
KOREA
Yamaha Music Korea Ltd.
Tong-Yang Securities Bldg. 16F 23-8 Yoido-dong,
Youngdungpo-ku, Seoul, Korea
Tel: 02-3770-0661
MALAYSIA
Yamaha Music Malaysia, Sdn., Bhd.
Lot 8, Jalan Perbandaran, 47301 Kelana Jaya,
Petaling Jaya, Selangor, Malaysia
Tel: 3-703-0900
PHILIPPINES
Yupangco Music Corporation
339 Gil J. Puyat Avenue, P.O. Box 885 MCPO,
Makati, Metro Manila, Philippines
Tel: 819-7551
SINGAPORE
Yamaha Music Asia Pte., Ltd.
11 Ubi Road #06-00, Meiban Industrial Building,
Singapore
Tel: 65-747-4374
TAIWAN
Yamaha KHS Music Co., Ltd.
10F, 150, Tun-Hwa Northroad,
Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C.
Tel: 02-2713-8999
THAILAND
Siam Music Yamaha Co., Ltd.
121/60-61 RS Tower 17th Floor,
Ratchadaphisek RD., Dindaeng,
Bangkok 10320, Thailand
Tel: 02-641-2951
THE PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA
AND OTHER ASIAN COUNTRIES
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: 053-460-2317
AUSTRALIA
Yamaha Music Australia Pty. Ltd.
Level 1, 99 Queensbridge Street, Southbank, Victoria
3006, Australia
Tel: 3-9693-5111
NEW ZEALAND
Music Houses of N.Z. Ltd.
146/148 Captain Springs Road, Te Papapa,
Auckland, New Zealand
Tel: 9-634-0099
COUNTRIES AND TRUST
TERRITORIES IN PACIFIC OCEAN
Yamaha Corporation,
Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: 053-460-2312
NORTH AMERICA
CENTRAL & SOUTH AMERICA
EUROPE
AFRICA
MIDDLE EAST
ASIA
OCEANIA
HEAD OFFICE Yamaha Corporation, Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: 053-460-2445
SY23
DIC 338
Yamaha Web Site (English only)
www.yamahasynth.com
Yamaha Manual Library
http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/
M.D.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation
C
2002 Yamaha Corporation
V941880 205APAP1.3-01A0 Printed in Japan
This document is printed on recycled chlorine free (ECF) paper with soy ink.
IMPORTANT
Check your power supply
Make sure that your local AC mains voltage matches the voltage specified on the name plate
on the bottom panel. In some areas a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of
the main keyboard unit. Make sure that the voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. The
voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped. To change the setting use a
"minus" screwdriver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage appears next to the
pointer on the panel.
Before using the PF-500, be sure to read
Precautions on pages 3-4.
PF-500
PF-500
Owner's Manual

Documenttranscriptie

PF-500 Owner's Manual Yamaha Web Site (English only) www.yamahasynth.com Yamaha Manual Library http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/ Before using the PF-500, be sure to read “Precautions„ on pages 3-4. IMPORTANT This document is printed on recycled chlorine free (ECF) paper with soy ink. M.D.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation C 2002 Yamaha Corporation V941880 205APAP1.3-01A0 Printed in Japan Check your power supply Make sure that your local AC mains voltage matches the voltage specified on the name plate on the bottom panel. In some areas a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of the main keyboard unit. Make sure that the voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. The voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped. To change the setting use a "minus" screwdriver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage appears next to the pointer on the panel. DIC 338 Introduction SPECIAL MESSAGE SECTION PRODUCT SAFETY MARKINGS: Yamaha electronic products may have either labels similar to the graphics shown below or molded/stamped facsimiles of these graphics on the enclosure. The explanation of these graphics appears on this page. Please observe all cautions indicated on this page and those indicated in the safety instruction section. Battery Notice: This product MAY contain a small non- rechargable battery which (if applicable) is soldered in place. The average life span of this type of battery is approximately five years. When replacement becomes necessary, contact a qualified service representative to perform the replacement. Warning: Do not attempt to recharge, disassemble, or incinerate this type of battery. Keep all batteries away from children. Dispose of used batteries promptly and as regulated by applicable laws. Note: In some areas, the servicer is required by law to return the defective parts. However, you do have the option of having the servicer dispose of these parts for you. CAUTION RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK. DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. Disposal Notice: Should this product become damaged See bottom of Keyboard enclosure for graphic symbol markings The exclamation point within the equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the product. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within the equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electrical shock. IMPORTANT NOTICE: All Yamaha electronic products are tested and approved by an independent safety testing laboratory in order that you may be sure that when it is properly installed and used in its normal and customary manner, all foreseeable risks have been eliminated. DO NOT modify this unit or commission others to do so unless specifically authorized by Yamaha. Product performance and/or safety standards may be diminished. Claims filed under the expressed warranty may be denied if the unit is/has been modified. Implied warranties may also be affected. SPECIFICATIONS SUBJECT TO CHANGE: The information contained in this manual is believed to be correct at the time of printing. However, Yamaha reserves the right to change or modify any of the specifications without notice or obligation to update existing units. beyond repair, or for some reason its useful life is considered to be at an end, please observe all local, state, and federal regulations that relate to the disposal of products that contain lead, batteries, plastics, etc. NOTICE: Service charges incurred due to lack of knowl- edge relating to how a function or effect works (when the unit is operating as designed) are not covered by the manufacturer’s warranty, and are therefore the owners responsibility. Please study this manual carefully and consult your dealer before requesting service. NAME PLATE LOCATION: The graphic below indicates the location of the name plate. The model number, serial number, power requirements, etc., are located on this plate. You should record the model number, serial number, and the date of purchase in the spaces provided below and retain this manual as a permanent record of your purchase. PF-500 Model Serial No. Purchase Date ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES: Yamaha strives to produce products that are both user safe and environmentally friendly. We sincerely believe that our products and the production methods used to produce them, meet these goals. In keeping with both the letter and the spirit of the law, we want you to be aware of the following: 2 PF-500 92-469 1 PRECAUTIONS PLEASE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING * Please keep this manual in a safe place for future reference. WARNING Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of serious injury or even death from electrical shock, short-circuiting, damages, fire or other hazards. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following: Power supply/Power cord Water warning • Only use the voltage specified as correct for the instrument. The required voltage is printed on the name plate of the instrument. • Do not expose the instrument to rain, use it near water or in damp or wet conditions, or place containers on it containing liquids which might spill into any openings. • Check the electric plug periodically and remove any dirt or dust which may have accumulated on it. • Never insert or remove an electric plug with wet hands. • Use only the supplied power cord/plug. Fire warning • Do not place the power cord near heat sources such as heaters or radiators, and do not excessively bend or otherwise damage the cord, place heavy objects on it, or place it in a position where anyone could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over it. • Do not put burning items, such as candles, on the unit. A burning item may fall over and cause a fire. If you notice any abnormality • If the power cord or plug becomes frayed or damaged, or if there is a sudden loss of sound during use of the instrument, or if any unusual smells or smoke should appear to be caused by it, immediately turn off the power switch, disconnect the electric plug from the outlet, and have the instrument inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel. Do not open • Do not open the instrument or attempt to disassemble the internal parts or modify them in any way. The instrument contains no user-serviceable parts. If it should appear to be malfunctioning, discontinue use immediately and have it inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel. CAUTION Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of physical injury to you or others, or damage to the instrument or other property. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following: Power supply/Power cord Location • When removing the electric plug from the instrument or an outlet, always hold the plug itself and not the cord. Pulling by the cord can damage it. • Remove the electric plug from the outlet when the instrument is not to be used for extended periods of time, or during electrical storms. • Do not connect the instrument to an electrical outlet using a multiple-connector. Doing so can result in lower sound quality, or possibly cause overheating in the outlet. • Do not expose the instrument to excessive dust or vibrations, or extreme cold or heat (such as in direct sunlight, near a heater, or in a car during the day) to prevent the possibility of panel disfiguration or damage to the internal components. • Do not use the instrument in the vicinity of a TV, radio, stereo equipment, mobile phone, or other electric devices. Otherwise, the instrument, TV, or radio may generate noise. • Do not place the instrument in an unstable position where it might accidentally fall over. • Before moving the instrument, remove all connected cables. Assembling the keyboard stand • Do not place objects in front of the instrument’s air vent, since this may prevent adequate ventilation of the internal components, and possibly result in the instrument overheating. • Read carefully this manual or the attached documentation explaining the assembly process. Failure to assemble the stand in the proper sequence might result in damage to the instrument or even injury. (1)B-7 1/2 PF-500 3 Connections Using the bench (If included) • Before connecting the instrument to other electronic components, turn off the power for all components. Before turning the power on or off for all components, set all volume levels to minimum. Also, be sure to set the volumes of all components at their minimum levels and gradually raise the volume controls while playing the instrument to set the desired listening level. • Do not place the bench in an unstable position where it might accidentally fall over. • Do not play carelessly with or stand on the bench. Using it as a tool or step-ladder or for any other purpose might result in accident or injury. • Only one person should sit on the bench at a time, in order to prevent the possibility of accident or injury. • If the bench screws become loose due to extensive long-term use, tighten them periodically using the included tool. Maintenance • When cleaning the instrument, use a soft, dry or slightly damp cloth. Do not use paint thinners, solvents, cleaning fluids, or chemical-impregnated wiping cloths. Saving data Saving and backing up your data • Current data (see page 43) is lost when you turn off the power to the instrument. Save the data to the storage memory (see page 43). Handling caution • Never insert or drop paper, metallic, or other objects into the gaps on the panel or keyboard. If this happens, turn off the power immediately and unplug the power cord from the AC outlet. Then have the instrument inspected by qualified Yamaha service personnel. • Do not place vinyl, plastic or rubber objects on the instrument, since this might discolor the panel or keyboard. • Do not rest your weight on, or place heavy objects on the instrument, and do not use excessive force on the buttons, switches or connectors. • Do not operate the instrument for a long period of time at a high or uncomfortable volume level, since this can cause permanent hearing loss. If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, consult a physician. Yamaha cannot be held responsible for damage caused by improper use or modifications to the instrument, or data that is lost or destroyed. Always turn the power off when the instrument is not in use. 4 (1)B-7 PF-500 2/2 Thank you for choosing the Yamaha PF-500 electronic piano. In order to make the most of your PF-500’s performance potential and features, please read this Owner’s Manual thoroughly, and keep it in a safe place for later reference. About this Owner’s Manual and Reference Booklet This manual consists of four main sections: “Introduction,” “Basic Operation,” “Detailed Settings,” and “Appendix.” Also, a separate “Reference Booklet” is provided. Introduction: Please read this section first. In the “Application Index” section on page 9 and “Features” on page 12, you can learn how to use the PF-500 and its functions in particular situations. Basic Operation: This main section explains how to use the basic functions. Refer to this section while you play the PF-500. If you have questions or come across the words you do not know, refer to the section entitled “Questions about Operations and Functions” on page 90, or the “Index” on page 102. Detailed Settings: This section explains how to make detailed settings for the PF-500’s various functions. Refer to this section as necessary. Appendix: This section introduces troubleshooting, a description of preset voices, and other reference material. Reference Booklet: XG Voice List, MIDI Data Format, etc. • The illustrations and LCD screens as shown in this Owner’s Manual are for instructional purposes only, and may appear somewhat different from those on your instrument. • Copying of the commercially available software is strictry prohibited except for your personal use. COPYRIGHT NOTICE This product incorporates and bundles computer programs and contents in which Yamaha owns copyrights or with respect to which it has license to use others’ copyrights. Such copyrighted materials include, without limitation, all computer software, MIDI files, WAVE data and sound recordings. Any unauthorized use of such programs and contents outside of personal use is not permitted under relevant laws. Any violation of copyright has legal consequences. DON’T MAKE, DISTRIBUTE OR USE ILLEGALCOPIES. ■ Trademarks • Apple and Macintosh are trademarks of Apple Computer, Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. • Windows is the registered trademark of Microsoft® Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders. PF-500 5 Table of contents Introduction.......................................................... 2 PRECAUTIONS ........................................................................................................................................ 3 About this Owner’s Manual and Reference Booklet..................................................................................................... 5 Table of contents ................................................................................................................................... 6 Application Index ................................................................................................................................... 9 Included Accessories ............................................................................................................................ 11 Features ................................................................................................................................................ 12 Before Using the PF-500 ...................................................................................................................... 14 About the pedal unit ..................................................................................................................................................... 14 About the music stand .................................................................................................................................................. 14 Turning the power on................................................................................................................................................... 15 Adjusting the display contrast ...................................................................................................................................... 16 Setting the volume ........................................................................................................................................................ 16 Using headphones......................................................................................................................................................... 16 Basic Operation .................................................. 17 Part Names ........................................................................................................................................... 18 Listening to the Demonstration Tunes................................................................................................ 20 Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs ..................................................................................................... 22 Playing the 50 piano preset songs ................................................................................................................................ 22 Practicing a one-hand part using 50 preset songs ....................................................................................................... 24 Selecting and Playing Voices ............................................................................................................... 26 Selecting Voices............................................................................................................................................................. 26 Using the pedals ............................................................................................................................................................ 27 Adding variation to the sound [BRILLIANCE]/[REVERB]/[CHORUS] ..................................................................................................................... 28 Combining two voices (Dual mode)............................................................................................................................ 30 Splitting the keyboard range and playing two different voices (Split mode) ............................................................ 32 Using the metronome ................................................................................................................................................... 34 Recording Your Performance............................................................................................................... 35 Recording a New Song.................................................................................................................................................. 35 Recording to [TRACK 1]........................................................................................................................................ 35 Re-recording TRACK 1........................................................................................................................................... 37 Re-recording TRACK 1 partially............................................................................................................................ 38 Recording to [TRACK2]......................................................................................................................................... 39 Recording to the third or more tracks [EXTRA TRACKS] .................................................................................. 40 Other recording techniques.......................................................................................................................................... 40 Adding data to or recording over an existing song ............................................................................................... 40 Changing a voice or tempo after recording ........................................................................................................... 41 Adjusting the volume balance between playback and your performance [SONG BALANCE] ......................... 42 Recording in Dual or Split mode ........................................................................................................................... 42 Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE] ...................................................................... 43 PF-500 memory....................................................................................................................................................... 43 Basic file operation.................................................................................................................................................. 44 Saving recorded or other songs to PF-500 Storage memory...[SaveToMemory]...................................................... 45 Deleting a Memory song...[DeleteSong]...................................................................................................................... 46 6 PF-500 Table of contents Renaming a song...[RenameSong] ............................................................................................................................... 47 Changing the type of characters on screen...[CharacterCode]................................................................................... 47 Playing Back Recorded Songs .............................................................................................................. 48 Playing back a song ....................................................................................................................................................... 48 Turning track playback on and off............................................................................................................................... 50 Supported song data type ............................................................................................................................................. 50 Connections ......................................................................................................................................... 51 Connectors .................................................................................................................................................................... 51 Connecting a personal computer ................................................................................................................................. 53 Detailed Settings ................................................ 59 Detailed Settings.................................................................................................................................. 60 Parameter List ............................................................................................................................................................... 60 Making detailed settings ............................................................................................................................................... 63 Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING] ........................................................ 65 Correcting note timing [Quantize].............................................................................................................................. 65 Specifying whether playback starts immediately along with the first voicing [QuickPlay] ...................................... 66 Auditioning the channels [ChannelListen] ................................................................................................................. 66 Deleting data from each channel [ChannelClear]....................................................................................................... 66 Specifying the range and playing back repeatedly [FromToRepeat] ......................................................................... 66 Playing back the phrase specified by the phrase number [PhraseMark] ................................................................... 67 Playing back a song repeatedly [SongRepeat] ............................................................................................................. 67 Detailed settings for the metronome METRONOME [SETTING] ........................................................ 68 Setting the metronome time signature [TimeSignature]............................................................................................ 68 Setting the metronome volume level [MetronomeVolume]...................................................................................... 68 Selecting the metronome voice [MetronomeSound] ................................................................................................. 68 Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] .............................................................................. 69 Setting the octave [Octave]........................................................................................................................................... 70 Setting the volume level [Volume] .............................................................................................................................. 70 Setting the position of right and left channels [Pan] .................................................................................................. 70 Make fine adjustments to the pitch (only in Dual mode) [Detune] .......................................................................... 70 Selecting the reverb type [ReverbType] ....................................................................................................................... 71 Setting the reverb depth [ReverbSend]........................................................................................................................ 71 Selecting the chorus type [Chorus Type]..................................................................................................................... 71 Setting the chorus depth [ChorusSend] ...................................................................................................................... 71 Setting the chorus on/off [ChorusOnOff]................................................................................................................... 72 Selecting the DSP type [DSP Type (DSP)] .................................................................................................................. 72 Setting the speed of the vibraphone vibrato effect [VibeRotorSpeed]....................................................................... 72 Turning the vibraphone vibrato effect on/off [VibeRotorOnOff (RotorOnOff)] .................................................... 73 Setting the rotation speed of the rotary speaker [RotarySpeed (Rot.Speed)]............................................................ 73 Adjusting the depth of the DSP effect [DSPDepth] .................................................................................................... 73 Adjusting the brightness of the sound [Brightness].................................................................................................... 73 Adjusting the resonance effect [HarmonicContent (Harmonic)] ............................................................................. 73 Adjusting the low-range frequency of the equalizer [EQ LowFreq. (EQ L.Freq)] .................................................... 74 Adjusting the low-range gain (amount of boost/cut) of the equalizer [EQ LowGain]............................................. 74 Adjusting the high-range frequency of the equalizer [EQ HighFreq. (EQ H.Freq)] ................................................ 74 Adjusting the high-range gain (amount of boost/cut) of the equalizer [EQ HighGain] .......................................... 74 PF-500 7 Table of contents Setting the touch sensitivity [TouchSense].................................................................................................................. 75 Setting the right pedal function [RPedal].................................................................................................................... 75 Setting the center pedal function [MPedal] ................................................................................................................ 75 Setting the left pedal function [LPedal] ....................................................................................................................... 76 Setting the auxiliary pedal function [AuxPedal] ......................................................................................................... 76 MIDI [MIDI SETTING]........................................................................................................................... 77 About MIDI................................................................................................................................................................... 77 Setting the MIDI transmit channel [MidiOutChannel] ............................................................................................. 78 Setting the MIDI receive channel [MidiInChannel]................................................................................................... 78 Setting Local control on/off [LocalControl]................................................................................................................ 79 Selecting performance from the keyboard or song data for MIDI transmission [MidiOutSelect].......................... 79 Selecting a type of data received via MIDI [ReceiveParameter]................................................................................. 79 Selecting a type of data transmitted via MIDI [TransmitParameter] ........................................................................ 79 Transmitting the initial settings on the panel [InitialSetup] ...................................................................................... 80 Executing voice data bulk dump [VoiceBulkDump].................................................................................................. 80 Other settings ...................................................................................................................................... 81 Selecting a touch response [TouchResponse] ............................................................................................................. 81 Fine tuning the pitch [Tune]........................................................................................................................................ 81 Selecting a tuning curve for a piano voice [PianoTuningCurve] ............................................................................... 81 Selecting a scale [Scale] ................................................................................................................................................. 82 Specifying the Split Point [SplitPoint]......................................................................................................................... 82 Changing the key [Transpose] ..................................................................................................................................... 82 Adjusting the depth of the Soft pedal [SoftPedalDepth] ............................................................................................ 83 Depth of string resonance [StringResonanceDepth] .................................................................................................. 83 Depth of sustain sampling for the damper pedal [SustainSamplingDepth].............................................................. 83 Specify the volume of the key-off sound [KeyOffSamplingDepth] ........................................................................... 83 Selecting a pedal function for vibraphone [VibraphonePedalMode] ........................................................................ 83 Assign the SONG [START/STOP] function to the pedal [PedalStart/Stop] ............................................................. 84 Selecting a type of auxiliary pedal [AuxPedalType].................................................................................................... 84 Setting the point at which the damper pedal starts to affect the sound [HalfPedalPoint] ....................................... 84 Pitch bend range [PitchBendRange]............................................................................................................................ 84 Switch the speaker on/off [Speaker] ............................................................................................................................ 85 Selecting items saved at shutdown [MemoryBackUp] ............................................................................................... 85 Restoring the normal (default) settings [FactorySet] ................................................................................................. 85 Other method for restoring the normal settings ......................................................................................................... 85 Message List ......................................................................................................................................... 86 Questions about Operations and Functions ........................................................................................ 90 Appendix ............................................................ 93 Troubleshooting................................................................................................................................... 94 Data Compatibility ............................................................................................................................... 95 Preset Voice List ................................................................................................................................... 97 Voice Combination Examples (Dual and Split) ................................................................................... 99 Assembling the Keyboard Stand ....................................................................................................... 100 Index................................................................................................................................................... 102 8 PF-500 Application Index Use this index to find reference pages that may be helpful for your application and situation. Listening Listening to demo songs...............................................“Listening to the Demonstration Tunes” on page 20 “Playing the 50 piano preset songs” on page 22 Listening to demo songs with different voices ............“Listening to the Demonstration Tunes” on page 20 Listening to songs from “50 greats for the Piano” ..............“Playing the 50 piano preset songs” on page 22 Listening to my recorded performance ............................................ “Recording to [TRACK 1]” on page 35 “Playing back a song” on page 48 Playing Using three pedals.............................................................................................“Using the pedals” on page 27 Playing an accompaniment that matches pitch ....................... “Changing the key [Transpose]” on page 82 Changing tonal color Viewing the list of voices .................................................................................. “Preset Voice List” on page 97 Simulating a concert hall........................................................................................... “[REVERB]” on page 29 Combining two voices ..................................................... “Combining two voices (Dual mode)” on page 30 Playing different sounds with left and right hands ........................... “Splitting the keyboard range and playing two different voices (Split mode)” on page 32 Making a voice brighter and sharper, or softer and smoother ........................“[BRILLIANCE]” on page 28 Adding spread to the sound .................................................................................... “[CHORUS]” on page 29 Practicing Muting the right- or left-hand part ........... “Practicing a one-hand part using 50 preset songs” on page 24 Practicing with an accurate and steady tempo.......................................“Using the metronome” on page 34 Practicing using your recorded song .......................................... “Recording Your Performance” on page 35 “Turning track playback on and off ” on page 50 Recording Recording your performance ...................................................... “Recording Your Performance” on page 35 Saving recorded songs to memory...“Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE]” on page 43 PF-500 9 Application Index Use this index to find reference pages that may be helpful for your application and situation. Settings Making detailed settings for recording and playback ............................................“Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING]” on page 65 Making detailed settings for the metronome ......................................... “Detailed settings for the metronome METRONOME [SETTING]” on page 68 Making detailed settings for the voices ................................................................. “Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING]” on page 69 Making detailed settings for MIDI .................................................... “MIDI [MIDI SETTING]” on page 77 Making detailed settings for the PF-500..............................................................“Other settings” on page 81 Connecting the PF-500 to other devices What is MIDI?......................................................................................................... “About MIDI” on page 77 Recording your performance “AUX OUT [R][L] Pin jacks (LEVEL FIXED), [R][L/L+R] Phone jacks” on page 52 Raising the volume .. “AUX OUT [R][L] Pin jacks (LEVEL FIXED), [R][L/L+R] Phone jacks” on page 52 Outputting other instruments’ sound from the PF-500............... “AUX IN [R], [L/L+R] jacks” on page 51 Connecting a computer........................................................ “Connecting a personal computer” on page 53 Assembling the keyboard stand Using the stand ..................................................................... “Assembling the Keyboard Stand” on page 100 Quick solution What the PF-500 offers.................................................................................... “Application Index” on page 9 “Features” on page 12 Returning to the main screen................................................................................. “EXIT button” on page 18 Resetting the PF-500 to the default setting ................................................................“Restoring the normal (default) settings [FactorySet]” on page 85 Meaning of the messages........................................................................................ “Message List” on page 86 If you have questions about operations and functions .............................................................................. “Questions about Operations and Functions” on page 90 Troubleshooting............................................................................................... “Troubleshooting” on page 94 10 PF-500 Included Accessories Pedal Unit Keyboard Stand Music Stand Bench (included or optional depending on locale) Dust Cover (included or optional depending on locale) Owner’s Manual Reference Booklet PF-500 11 Features The Yamaha PF-500 electronic piano features rich sounds produced by Yamaha’s proprietary “AWM dynamic stereo sampling” tone generator system and a “Graded Hammer” keyboard that varies the key weight according to the key range, giving these electronic pianos a “playing-feel” that is very close to the keyboard of a genuine grand piano. The PF-500 GrandPiano1 voice features 3 velocity-switched samples ( Dynamic Sampling), “String Resonance” (page 83) that recreates resonance of piano strings, special “Sustain Sampling” (page 83)that samples the unique resonance of an acoustic grand piano’s soundboard and strings when the damper pedal is pressed, and “Key-off Samples” that add the subtle sound produced when the keys are released. The PF-500 comes much closer to the sound of a true acoustic piano. TRACK 1 SONG SELECT SONG TOP METRONOME START/STOP SETTING TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD DOWN A B C D CONTRAST UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG TEMPO AUX IN AC INLET PHONES AUX OUT R L/L+R PEDAL A set of standard stereo headphones can be plugged in here for private practice. (page 16) You can output the sound of the PF-500 from an external audio system, or connect it to a cassette tape recorder etc. and record your playing. (page 52) These jacks allow you to connect an external tone generator to reproduce the sound via the PF-500’s internal sound system and speakers. (page 51) L/L+R EFFECT VOICE R L LEVEL FIXED R ON MIDI AUX PEDAL POWER HOST SELECT TO HOST OFF USB MIDI PC-2 Mac USB IN Connect an optional pedal here and assign one of the various functions to the pedal. (page 52) OUT THRU Connect a MIDI device here to use various MIDI functions. (page 52, 56) (About MIDI—page 77) This jack and selector switch allow direct connection to a personal computer for sequencing and other music applications. (page 53–58) 12 PF-500 This connector can be connected to your computer, allowing you to transfer MIDI data between the PF-500 and the computer. (page 52) Features SONG select buttons This section enables you to listen to 50 piano preset songs, as well as to practice playing the songs using a convenient Practice function. You can also record and play back your performance. (page 22, 35, 48) [METRONOME] Use the metronome functions. (page 34) [CONTRAST] Adjust the brightness of the display using this control. (page 16) [DEMO] Demonstration playback is available for each voice. (page 20) SONG SELECT [REVERB] / [CHORUS] Add reverb (reverberation) and spread (chorus) to the sound. (page 29) Voice group buttons You can choose from sixteen groups of voices, including grand piano. You can also combine two sounds and use them together. (page 26) [MASTER VOLUME] Adjust the volume level using this dial. (page 16) SONG [MIDI SETTING] Make detailed MIDI settings, such as MIDI receive/transmit channels. (page 77) [FILE] Save recorded songs and manage song files. (page 43) TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING [SPLIT] You can play different voices on the left- and right-hand sections of the keyboard. (page 32) CONTRAST B A NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO [SONG SETTING] Make detailed settings for song recording and playback. (page 65) [SONG BALANCE] This lets you adjust the volume balance between the song playback and the sound you are playing on the keyboard. (page 42) TEMPO [DOWN] [UP] You can change the song tempo (speed). (page 23, 34, 36, 48) VOICE The display allows accurate control and operation. (page 19) EFFECT [EXIT] The screen returns to its main display when you press this button. (page 19) [VOICE SETTING] / [VARIATION] You can make detailed settings for tone and effects. (page 69) BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] [BRIGHT] Adjust the brightness of the tone using these buttons. (page 28) [OTHER SETTING] This lets you make detailed settings, such as adjusting the keyboard touch or making fine adjustments to the pitch. (page 81) PF-500 13 Before Using the PF-500 You do not need to install the stand to play the PF-500. However, if you wish to assemble the stand, refer to page 100. About the pedal unit Insert the plug of the pedal unit, with the arrow in the plug facing upward. L/L+RAUX IN R L/L+R AUX AC R OUT INLET L LEVEL FIXED R PEDAL AUX PHONE S PEDAL POWE ON R MIDI OFF HOST IN MIDI SELEC Mac T PC-2 OUT USB THRU About the music stand The PF-500 is supplied with a music stand that can be attached to the instrument by inserting it into the holes at the rear of the control panel. 14 PF-500 TO HOST USB Before Using the PF-500 Turning the power on 1. Connect the power cable. First insert the plug of the power cable into the [AC INLET] on the left side panel, then plug the other end of the cable into the proper AC outlet on the wall. 1 2 AC INLET L/L+RAUX (The shape of plug differs depending on locale.) IN R L/L+R AUX AC R OUT INLET L LEVEL FIXED R PEDAL AUX PHONE S PEDAL POWE ON R MIDI 240V OFF HOST IN MIDI SELEC Mac T PC-2 OUT USB TO HOST USB 220V THRU 0V 11 13 0V VOLTAGE SELECTOR WARNING! Make sure your PF-500 is rated for the AC voltage supplied in the area in which it is to be used (voltage rating appears on the name plate on the bottom panel). In some areas, a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of the main keyboard unit. Make sure that the voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. Connecting the unit to the wrong AC supply can cause serious damage to the internal circuitry and may even pose a shock hazard! Use only the AC power cord supplied with the PF-500. If the supplied cord is lost or damaged and needs to be replaced, contact your Yamaha dealer. The use of an inappropriate replacement can pose a fire and shock hazard! The type of AC power cord provided with the PF-500 may be different depending on the country in which it is purchased. (In some areas a plug adaptor may be provided to match the pin configuration of the AC wall outlets in your area.) Do NOT modify the plug provided with the PF-500. If the plug will not fit the outlet, have a proper outlet installed by a qualified electrician. 2. Turn on the power to the PF-500. Press the [POWER] switch located on the left side panel to turn on the power. • The screen located in the center of the front panel lights up. A L/L+RAUX B POWER IN R ON L/L+R AUX AC R OUT INLET L OFF LEVEL FIXED R PEDAL AUX PHONE S PEDAL NO POWE ON R MIDI OFF HOST IN MIDI SELEC Mac T YES PC-2 OUT USB THRU TO HOST USB [POWER] C D When you turn on the power to the PF-500, a voice name appears on the screen. Press the [POWER] switch again to turn off the power to the PF-500. PF-500 15 Before Using the PF-500 Adjusting the display contrast You can adjust the contrast of the display by turning the [CONTRAST] knob located to the right of the LCD. A CONTRAST B Use this knob. NO YES EXIT C D TERMINOLOGY CONTRAST: difference between brightness and darkness Setting the volume To adjust the volume, use the [MASTER VOLUME] located at the left of the panel. Play the keyboard to actually produce sound while you adjust the volume. The level decreases. MIN TERMINOLOGY MASTER VOLUME: The volume level of the entire keyboard sound The level increases. CAUTION Do not use the PF-500 at a high volume level for a long period of time, or your hearing may be damaged. MAX MASTER VOLUME TIP You can also adjust the [PHONES] output level, the AUX IN input level and the AUX OUT [L/L+R][R] output level using the [MASTER VOLUME] dial. Using headphones Connect a pair of headphones to one of the [PHONES] on the left side panel. Two [PHONES] jacks are provided. Two sets of standard stereo headphones can be plugged in. (If you are using only one pair of headphones, you can plug them into either of these jacks.) CAUTION Do not use headphones at a high volume for an extended period of time. Doing so may cause hearing loss. PHONES L/L+RAUX IN R L/L+R AUX AC R OUT INLET L LEVEL FIXED R PEDAL AUX PHONE S PEDAL POWE ON R MIDI OFF HOST IN MIDI SELEC Mac T PC-2 OUT USB THRU 16 PF-500 TO HOST USB Basic Operation PF-500 17 Part Names C B CONTRAST B NO F D YES GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG G H VOICE SETTING SPLIT I J REVERB CHORUS M MIDI SETTING VARIATION BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT OTHER SETTING K EFFECT N EXIT E D VOICE L 5 SONG SELECT SONG MIN TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS TOP START/STOP REC NEW SONG MAX SONG BALANCE DEMO 1 2 3 4 SYNCHRO START SONG SETTING 8 SONG B METRONOME START/STOP SETTING FILE KEYBOARD MASTER VOLUME 0 6 DOWN 9 C A UP C TEMPO A 7 ] TRACK 1 SONG SELECT SONG TOP TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING DOWN A B C D CONTRAST UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN O P NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG TEMPO VOICE EFFECT Q A-1 B-1 C0 D0 E0 F0 G0 A0 B0 C1 D1 E1 F1 G1 A1 B1 C2 D2 E2 F2 G2 A2 B2 C3 D3 E3 F3 G3 A3 B3 C4 D4 E4 F4 G4 A4 B4 C5 D5 E5 F5 G5 A5 B5 C6 D6 E6 F6 G6 A6 B6 C7 Center “C” Top panel 1 [MASTER VOLUME]............................. P16 2 SONG BALANCE.................................. P42 3 [DEMO] ............................................... P20 4 SONG SELECT [ ] [ 5 [TRACK1] [TRACK2] / ] ........ P22, 35, 48 [EXTRA TRACKS] ............... P24, 35–40, 50 6 [FILE] ................................................... P43 7 [TOP] / SONG [START/STOP] ................................................ P22, 36, 49 8 [REC] ................................................... P34 9 [SONG SETTING] ................................ P65 0 METRONOME [START/STOP] / [SETTING] ..................................... P34, 68 A TEMPO [DOWN] [UP] ....... P23, 34, 36, 49 B LCD buttons A [–] [+] / B [– (NO)] [+ (YES)] / C [–] [+] / D [–] [+] .............................. P19 18 PF-500 C LCD screen ..........................................P19 D [CONTRAST] knob ..............................P16 E [EXIT]...................................................P19 F Voice group buttons ...........................P26 G [VOICE SETTING] ................................P69 H [SPLIT] .................................................P32 I [REVERB] .............................................P29 J [CHORUS]............................................P29 K VARIATION [▼] [▲] .............................P26 L BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] [BRIGHT] ......P28 M [MIDI SETTING] ..................................P77 N [OTHER SETTING] ...............................P81 O Soft pedal............................................P27 P Sostenuto pedal ..................................P27 Q Damper pedal .....................................P27 Part Names Connectors (Left side panel) R AUX IN ............................................... P51 S AUX OUT ........................................... P52 T [PHONES] .......................................... P16 U [POWER ON/OFF].............................. P15 V [AC INLET] ......................................... P15 W [PEDAL]...................................... P14, 101 S R AUX IN L/L+R AC INLET X [AUX PEDAL] ...................................... P52 Y MIDI [IN] [OUT] [THRU] .................... P52 Z HOST SELECT ..................................... P52 [ [TO HOST].......................................... P52 \ [USB] .................................................. P52 AUX OUT R L/L+R PEDAL R T U PHONES POWER L LEVEL FIXED R ON MIDI AUX PEDAL HOST SELECT OFF TO HOST USB [ \ MIDI PC-2 Mac USB IN V W X OUT THRU Y Z ] Panel logos GM System Level 1 “GM System Level 1” is an addition to the MIDI standard which guarantees that any data conforming to the standard will play accurately on any GM-compatible tone generator or synthesizer from any manufacturer. XG Format XG is a new Yamaha MIDI specification which significantly expands and improves on the “GM System Level 1” standard with greater voice handling capacity, expressive control, and effect capability while retaining full compatibility with GM. C LCD Use the LCD button A, B, C, or D to select the contents displayed on the LCD. Check the screen located in the center of the top panel after every operation. A voice name appears on the screen when you turn on the power to the unit. A B NO C YES D E [EXIT] button When you press this button, the unit returns to the default screen (the screen that indicates a voice name(s) and is displayed when the power is turned on). PF-500 19 Listening to the Demonstration Tunes For each voice group, the PF-500 contains one demo song that shows off the character of the voices. This section explains how to listen to the demo songs for the voice groups listed below. Demonstration tunes Voice group Tunes HARPSICHORD Composer Gavotte J.S.Bach The demonstration pieces listed above are short rearranged excerpts the original compositions. All other songs are original (©2002 Yamaha Corporation). 2 3 1 4 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP Voice group buttons GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG 3 C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT 4 Procedure 1. Engage the demo mode. Press the [DEMO] button to engage the demo mode. The indicators of the voice group buttons will blink in succession. 20 PF-500 TERMINOLOGY Mode: A mode is a status under which you can execute a certain function. In demo mode, you can play back demonstration tunes. Listening to the Demonstration Tunes 2. Select a tune and start playback. Press the voice group button for the demo song that you want to hear. The indicator of the voice group button you pressed will light, and the demo song will begin playing. Subsequently, the demo songs will play back consecutively from the upper left voice group button until you stop the playback. 3. 4. Stop the playback. Press the button of the voice group being played or the SONG [START/STOP] button. NOTE To adjust the volume level of the demo songs, use the [MASTER VOLUME] dial. TIP To adjust the volume balance between the song playback and the sound you are playing on the keyboard, use the [SONG BALANCE] slider (page 42) . Exit from demo mode. Press the [DEMO] or [EXIT] button to exit from demo mode. By holding down [DEMO] and pressing A[–][+] to get the [PianoDemo] display, you can hear the piano demo. The piano demo lets you compare the result of enabling/disabling each sampling technology. GRAND PIANO1 ................. Stereo Piano (stereo sampling) GRAND PIANO2 ................. Mono Piano (mono sampling) E.PIANO1 ............................ mezzo piano (dynamic sampling, mezzopiano) E.PIANO2 ............................ mezzo forte (dynamic sampling, mezzoforte) HARPSICHORD .................. forte (dynamic sampling, forte) E.CLAVICHORD.................. with Sustain (with sustain sampling) VIBRAPHONE ..................... no Sustain (without sustain sampling) GUITAR ............................... with KeyOff (with key-off sampling) CHURCH ORGAN............... no KeyOff (without key-off sampling) JAZZ ORGAN...................... with StringRes (with string resonance) STRINGS............................. no StringRes (without string resonance) PF-500 21 Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs The PF-500 provides performance data of 50 piano songs. You can just listen to these songs (page 22) or use them for practice (page 24). See page 34 in the Reference Booklet for a complete listening of the preset songs. Playing the 50 piano preset songs 1 METRONOME [START/STOP] SONG SELECT SONG METRONOME START/STOP SETTING TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE SYNCHRO START DEMO SONG 3 2 C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT 4 TEMPO [DOWN] [UP] Procedure 1. Select a song. Press one of the [SONG SELECT] buttons repeatedly to select the desired piano song from P-001 to P-050. Song select screen A B NO C TERMINOLOGY Song: On the PF-500, performance data is called a “Song.” This includes demonstration tunes and piano preset tunes. YES D The song number appears on the display. 2. Play a preset song. Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to start playback. the number of measures A B NO C YES D TIP • You can also use the C [–]/[+] buttons to select a song after pressing the [SONG SELECT] button. • [P-000: NewSong] is a blank song provided for you to record your performance. (See page 35.) • Use the SongRepeat parameter in the “SONG SETTING” menu to select repeat playback of all songs or repeat playback of a single song. (See page 67.) TIP You can play the keyboard along with the preset song playback. You can change the voice playing on the keyboard. 22 PF-500 Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs Adjusting the tempo You can use the TEMPO [DOWN]/[UP] buttons to adjust the playback tempo as required. The default tempo (the song’s original tempo) is set when you press the [DOWN] and [UP] buttons simultaneously. Press either of the SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons to return to the song select screen. A B NO C 3. YES TIP You can also use the D[–]/[+] buttons to change the tempo. NOTE Resetting the tempo Whenever you select a new preset song, the tempo is automatically reset to the song’s original value. D Stop the song playback. When playback is complete, it automatically stops and the PF-500 locates the top of the song. To stop playback in the middle of a song, press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by pressing the SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you press the button. Fast forward and rewind You can perform the following operations in the song select screen: • Use the B [–]/[+] buttons to move back and forth (rewind and fast forward) through the song while the song is played or stopped. • Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C [–] button during playback to restart playback from the top of the song. • Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C [+] button during playback to start playback from the next song. • Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C [–] button while playback is stopped in the middle of the song to locate the top of the song. 4. Return to the default screen. Press the [EXIT] button. TERMINOLOGY Default screen: The default screen is a voice select screen (page 26) that appears when you turn on the power to the PF-500. PF-500 23 Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs Practicing a one-hand part using 50 preset songs The 50 preset songs have separate left- and right-hand parts on individual tracks. You can turn the left- and right-hand parts on or off as required so you can practice the corresponding part (the part that is turned off) on the keyboard. The right-hand part is played by [TRACK 1] and the left-hand part is played by [TRACK 2]. 1 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT 3 2 procedure 1. Turn off the playback part you wish to practice. After you select a song to practice, press the [TRACK1] or [TRACK2] button to turn off the corresponding part. TIP You can turn parts on or off, even during playback. When you first select a song, both [TRACK1] and [TRACK2] indicators light up, indicating that you can play back both parts. When you press one of the buttons to turn off playback, the corresponding button indicator turns off and the corresponding part playback is muted. Pressing the buttons repeatedly toggles between playback on and off. 2. Start playback and playing. Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to start playback. Play the part you just turned off. Starting playback automatically as you start playing the keyboard (Synchro Start) You can cause playback to begin when you play the keyboard (Synchro Start). Hold down [TOP] and press SONG [START/STOP]. The SONG [START/STOP] indicator will blink, and the PF-500 will wait for Syncro Start. Now when you play the keyboard, playback will begin at the same moment. If you press [TOP] while waiting, Synchro Start will be cancelled. 24 PF-500 TERMINOLOGY Synchro: Synchronous;occurring at the same time Listening to 50 Piano Preset Songs 3. Stop playback. When playback is complete, it automatically stops and the PF-500 locates the top of the song. If you wish to stop playback in the middle of a song, press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by pressing the SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you press the button. TIP Resetting the part playback Both parts are automatically turned ON whenever you select a new song. You can also assign a phrase in a song to repeatedly practice that part. Refer to the [FromToRepeat] option in the “SONG SETTING” menu on page 66. PF-500 25 Selecting and Playing Voices Selecting Voices SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN Voice group buttons 1 2 YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG 2 VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT Procedure 1. 2. Select a voice group. Press a voice group button. Select a voice. Use VARIATION [▼][▲] or A [–][+] to select a voice. If you select XG If you select XG, you can select the XG voice group first, then select the desired voice. 2-1. Simultaneously press the [–][+] screen buttons located beside the XG voice name display, to access a screen where you can select XG voices. 2-2. Use A [–][+] to select the voice group. 2-3. Use C [–][+] to select the desired voice. Voice group GRANDPIANO1 GRANDPIANO2 E.PIANO1 E.PIANO2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR Voice name GrandPiano1 MellowPiano RockPiano HonkyTonkPiano GrandPiano2 BrightPiano E.Piano1 SynthPiano E.Piano2 Vintage E.Piano Harpsichord8' Harpsichord8'+4' E.Clavichord Wah Clavi. Vibraphone Marimba Celesta NylonGuitar SteelGuitar Voice group CHURCHORGAN JAZZORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH.PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG Voice name PipeOrganPrincipal PipeOrganTutti PipeOrganFlute1 PipeOrganFlute2 JazzOrgan RotaryOrgan MellowOrgan Strings SynthStrings SlowStrings Choir SlowChoir Scat SynthPad1 SynthPad2 WoodBass Bass&Cymbal ElectricBass FretlessBass XGVoice • For details on XG voices, refer to “XG voice list” (the separate data list booklet). 26 PF-500 TERMINOLOGY Voice On the PF-500, a voice means “tone” or “tonal color.” TIP You can also switch between voices in the same group by pressing a voice group button repeatedly. TIP To learn characteristics of the voices, listen to demo songs for each voice group (page 20). Refer to “Preset Voice List” on page 97 for more information on characteristics of each preset voice. TIP You can control the loudness of a voice by how hard you play the keyboard, although different playing styles (touch sensitivities) have little or no effect with the sound of certain musical instruments. Refer to “Preset Voice List” on page 97. TIP XG is a major enhancement of the GM System level 1 format, and was developed by Yamaha specially to provide more voices and variations, as well as greater expressive control over voices and effects, and to ensure compatibility of data well into the future. TIP If you select XG and then simultaneously press the VARIATION [▼][▲] buttons, the XG voice select screen will appear. Selecting and Playing Voices Using the pedals The PF-500 has three foot pedals: damper pedal (right), sostenuto pedal (center), and soft pedal (left) that produce a range of expressive effects similar to those produced by the pedals on an acoustic piano. Damper (right) pedal When you press the damper pedal, the notes you play have a longer sustain. When you select Grand Piano 1, pressing the damper pedal activates the instrument’s special “Sustain Samples” to accurately recreate the unique resonance of an acoustic grand piano’s soundboard and strings.      When you press the damper pedal here, the notes you play before you release the pedal have a longer sustain. Sostenuto (center) pedal If you play a note or chord on the keyboard and press the sostenuto pedal while holding the note(s), the notes will sustain as long as the pedal is held. All subsequent notes will not sustain.      TIP If the damper pedal doesn’t work, or notes are sustained even when the pedal is not pressed, make sure that the pedal cord is properly plugged into the PEDAL jack on the unit (see page 14). Also, make sure that the RPedal parameter in the “VOICE SETTING” menu is set to ON (see page 75). TIP You can adjust the depth of the resonance produced by the “Sustain Samples” using the Sustain Sampling Depth parameter in the “OTHER SETTING” menu. (See page 83.) When you press the sostenuto pedal here while holding the note(s), the notes will sustain as long as you hold the pedal. Soft pedal (left) The soft pedal reduces the volume and slightly changes the timbre of notes played while the pedal is pressed. (The soft pedal will not affect notes that are already playing when it is pressed. Press the pedal immediately before you play the target notes.) With the Vibraphone and Jazz Organ voices, this pedal turns vibrato on and off or toggles the speed of vibrato. (See page 83.) TIP You can assign a function to each pedal via the “R Pedal”, “M Pedal”, and “L Pedal” parameters in the “VOICE SETTING” menu. (See pages 75, 76.) TIP The center and left pedals can also be assigned to song start/stop operation (START/STOP function) via the “PedalStart/Stop” parameter in the “OTHER SETTING” menu (on page 84). PF-500 27 Selecting and Playing Voices Adding variation to the sound [BRILLIANCE]/[REVERB]/[CHORUS] The Effect function enables you to add expression to the sound. The PF-500 effects include Brilliance, Reverb, and Chorus. [REVERB] [CHORUS] SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] / [BRIGHT] [BRILLIANCE] You can use this control to adjust the brilliance of the tone and change the tonality to suit your preference. Procedure Press one of the BRILLIANCE [MELLOW]/ [BRIGHT] buttons to select the desired tonality. A B NO C Mellow3 Mellow2 Mellow1 YES D Soft and mellow tone. The sound becomes more mellow and rounder as the number increases. Normal........... Standard tone Bright1 Bright2 Bright tone. The sound becomes brighter as the number increases. Bright3 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the main screen. 28 PF-500 TIP You can press BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] [BRIGHT], and then use D [–][+] to select the desired tonality. TIP Normal setting = Normal TERMINOLOGY Normal setting: The “Normal setting” refers to the default setting (factory setting) obtained when you first turn on the power to the PF-500. NOTE If you select [Bright1], [Bright2] or [Bright3] as the type of brilliance, the volume level will increase slightly. Under this condition, if you raise the [MASTER VOLUME] dial setting, the sound may become distorted. In this case, lower the volume accordingly. Selecting and Playing Voices [REVERB] This control adds reverberation to the sound by simulating the natural reverberation of a concert hall. Procedure Pressing the [REVERB] button repeatedly toggles the reverb on and off. Even if the reverb effect is turned off, a “soundboard reverb” effect will be applied when the GrandPiano1 or GrandPiano2 voice is selected. TIP You can select a reverb type via the Reverb Type parameter in the “VOICE SETTING” menu, and adjust the reverb depth for the selected voice via the Reverb Send parameter. (See page 71.) TIP Normal setting = ON [CHORUS] This control adds spread and spaciousness to the sound. Procedure Pressing the [CHORUS] button repeatedly toggles the chorus on and off. You can turn the chorus effect on and off by pressing the [CHORUS] ON/OFF buttons on the panel and by setting the Chorus On Off parameter in the VOICE SETTING menu (see page 72). The [CHORUS] ON/OFF button setting on the panel is temporary. That is, if you select another voice, the chorus setting for the previous voice is cancelled. The Chorus On Off parameter setting is saved for each voice. That is, if you select a given voice, the chorus setting is automatically turned on or off according to the saved chorus setting. TIP You can select a chorus type via the Chorus Type parameter in the “VOICE SETTING” menu, and adjust the chorus depth for the selected voice via the Reverb Send parameter. You can also turn chorus on or off via the Chorus On Off parameter. (See page 71.) TIP Normal Setting The normal chorus on/off setting is different for each voice. PF-500 29 Selecting and Playing Voices Combining two voices (Dual mode) You can play two voices simultaneously across the entire range of the keyboard. In this way, you can simulate a melody duet or combine two similar voices to create a thicker sound. Refer to “Voice Combination Examples (Dual and Split)” on page 99 for examples of effective voice combinations. The numbers on the upper row indicate the steps in Dual mode using voices from different groups. SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING 2 A CONTRAST B NO DOWN 1 3 2 YES UP Voice group buttons GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO The numbers on the bottom row indicate the steps in Dual mode using voices from the same group. VOICE 2 3 1 4 EFFECT Voice group buttons Dual mode using voices in different voice groups Procedure 1. Enter Dual mode. Press two voice group buttons simultaneously. Voice 1 Voice 2 A B NO C 2. YES D Select a voice. Use the A [–]/[+] buttons and B [–]/[+] buttons to select a voice. The voices listed in the upper row in “Preset Voice List” on page 97 are called voice 1, and those listed in the bottom row are called voice 2. 3. 30 PF-500 Exit Dual mode and return to normal play mode. Press any voice group button. TIP If you want to select Dual mode for the left-hand area when the entire keyboard is divided into left and right areas (page 32), hold down [SPLIT] and simultaneously press two voice group buttons. TIP You can also use the VARIATION [▼]/[▲] buttons to select the voice 1. TIP Refer to page 26 for details on how to select XG voices. Selecting and Playing Voices Dual mode using voices in the same voice group Procedure 1. 2. 3. Select a voice group. In normal play mode, press the desired voice group button. Select a voice. Use the A [–]/[+] buttons to select a voice. TIP If you want to select Dual mode for the left-hand area when the entire keyboard is devided into left and right areas (page 32), press D [–] [+]. Select another voice. Use the B [–]/[+] buttons to select another voice in the same voice group. To use the identical voices, press the B [–]/[+] buttons once. To use different voices within the same voice group, press the B [–]/[+] buttons repeatedly. A B NO C 4. YES D Exit Dual mode and return to normal play mode. Press any voice group button. PF-500 31 Selecting and Playing Voices Splitting the keyboard range and playing two different voices (Split mode) Split mode enables you to play two different voices on the keyboard — one with the left hand and another with the right hand. For example, you can play a bass part using the [WOOD BASS] or [E. BASS] voice with the left hand, and a melody with the right hand. Refer to “Voice Combination Examples (Dual and Split)” on page 99 for examples of effective voice combinations. 2 3 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP 1 3 4 5 GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO EFFECT VOICE 3 4 Voice group buttons 2 Procedure 1. 2. 3. Enter Split mode. Press [SPLIT]. Select a voice for the right hand. Use the voice group buttons and VARIATION [▼][▲] to select the voice for the right-hand area. TIP You can also use A [–][+] to select a voice for the righthand area. Select a voice for the left hand. Hold down [SPLIT], and press a voice group button to select the voice group for the left-hand area. TIP Refer to page 26 for details on how to select XG voice. Use C [–][+] to select a voice. 32 PF-500 Selecting and Playing Voices 4. Specify the split point (the border between the rightand left-hand range).  The normal setting of the split point is “F 2.” F2 TIP A specified “split point” key is included in the left-hand range. TIP The split point can also be set by the [OTHER SETTING] parameter [SplitPoint]. (page 69) Center “C” To change the split point setting: Hold down [SPLIT], then use the D [–]/[+] to specify the split point. (Optional) Press and hold down the [SPLIT] and play the key you wish to assign as the split point. A B NO C YES D Release the [SPLIT] button to return to the main screen. 5. Exit Split mode and return to normal play mode. Press [SPLIT]. You can use Dual (see page 30) in each area (right-hand and left-hand) of Split mode. A B NO C YES D PF-500 33 Selecting and Playing Voices Using the metronome The PF-500 is built-in metronome (a device that keeps an accurate tempo) is a convenient feature for practice. 1 2 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT TEMPO [DOWN] [UP] Procedure 1. Start the metronome. Press the METRONOME [START/STOP] button. When the metronome is sounding, the beat indicator flashes at the current tempo. Adjusting the tempo Press the TEMPO [DOWN] or [UP] button. A B NO C YES D To adjust the tempo (number of beats per minute: 10–500), use the TEMPO [DOWN]/[UP] or the D [–]/[+] buttons. To reset the tempo to the normal (default) setting, press the [DOWN] and [UP] keys or the D [–] and [+] keys simultaneously. Press the [EXIT] button to return to the normal screen. 2. 34 PF-500 TIP The default tempo is 120. (If a song has been selected, the song tempo is used.) Stop the metronome. Press the METRONOME [START/STOP] button. TIP You can set the time signature, metronome volume, and metronome tone using the METRONOME [SETTING] button. (See page 68.) Recording Your Performance TIP You can record your performance (audio data) to a cassette tape recorder or other recording devices via the AUX OUT connector. (see page 52.) This chapter explains how to record your performance using the PF-500 recording function. You can, for example, play back what you have played on the PF-500 keyboard for an effective practice aid. You can also record just the left-hand part, then practice the right-hand part while playing back the recorded left-hand part. Since you can record up to sixteen tracks separately, you could record the leftand right-hand parts separately, or record each part of a four-handed performance or ensemble song one by one to build a song. TERMINOLOGY Recording vs. Saving: The format of performance data recorded on a cassette tape differs from that of data recorded on the PF-500. A cassette tape records audio signals. On the other hand, the PF-500 “saves” information regarding note timing, voices, and a tempo value, but not audio signals. When you play back recorded songs, the PF-500 produces sound based on the saved information. Therefore, recording on the PF-500 may be more accurately called “saving information.” However, this book often uses the word “recording” because it seems to make more sense. A message (information or confirmation dialog) sometimes appears on the screen to facilitate operation. Refer to the “Message List” on page 86 for an explanation of each message, appropriate actions to take, and troubleshooting information. Recording a New Song Recording to [TRACK 1] 2 1 3 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT 4 4 5 Procedure 1. Select “NewSong” for recording. Press the SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons simultaneously. New Song screen A B NO C NOTE If you select a song other than “P-000: NewSong” and record on a track that already has data, the existing data on the track will be lost. YES D PF-500 35 Recording Your Performance 2. 3. Select a voice. Select a voice (or voices) for recording (see page 26). NOTE Set the tempo in Step 3. Set the other parameters, such as reverb and chorus. Adjust the [MASTER VOLUME] dial to set the volume level to suit your preference. You can also use the dial to adjust the level during playback. After you set the tempo or if the record standby screen does not appear, press one of the SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons once to return to the New Song screen. NOTE See page 42 for more information on recording in Dual/ Split mode. Enter record mode and select a recording track. Press and hold down the [REC] button and press the [TRACK 1] button. The [TRACK 1] indicator flashes in red. (To cancel recording, press the [REC] or [TOP] button.) Record standby screen A B NO C YES D Set the tempo, if necessary. If this record standby screen does not appear, press one of the SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons once. 4. Start and stop recording. Recording begins automatically as soon as you play a note on the keyboard. (Optional) Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to start recording. The recording screen displays the current measure number. Record screen A B NO C YES D TIP You can record data while using the metronome. The metronome is not recorded. TIP When you press the SONG [START/STOP] button during recording, recording is paused. To resume recording, press the SONG [START/STOP] button again or play a note on the keyboard. Measure number in recording To stop recording, press the [TOP] button. The PF-500 locates the top of the song. The [TRACK 1] indicator lights up in green. (Record mode is automatically cancelled.) 36 PF-500 TIP When you press the [REC] button, recording pauses. Recording Your Performance 5. Play back the recorded performance. Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to play back the recorded performance. When playback is complete, it automatically stops and the PF-500 locates the top of the song. To stop playback in the middle of a song, press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by pressing the SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you press the button. NOTE To erase recorded data from a track, use the Channel Clear parameter in the “SONG SETTING” menu. (See page 66.) When you turn off the power to the PF-500, the recorded performance data will be lost. If you wish to keep the recording, save the data using the SaveToMemory parameter (page 45) in the File menu. Re-recording TRACK 1 This section explains how to record again in case your performance was not satisfactory. Procedure 1. Select a voice or voices for recording, if necessary. Repeat Step 2 on page 36 if you wish to change the previous settings. Follow the procedure from Step 3 on page 36 to re-record. The original performance data will be overwritten by new performance data. PF-500 37 Recording Your Performance Re-recording TRACK 1 partially This section explains how to record part of a song again. Procedure 1. Pause the song at the beginning of the part you wish to re-record. Use the B [–]/[+] buttons while the playback screen is displayed to move through the measures or play back the recording and press the SONG [START/STOP] button to locate a point slightly prior to the beginning of the part you wish to re-record. NOTE If the playback screen is not displayed, press one of the SONG SELECT [ ][ ] buttons once. Playback screen A B NO C 2. 3. 3-1 YES D Select a voice or voices for recording, if necessary. Repeat Step 2 on page 36 if you wish to change the previous settings. Select the recording method and enter record mode. Press and hold down the [REC] button, and press the C [–]/[+] buttons repeatedly to specify how the recording should start and press the D [–]/[+] buttons repeatedly to specify how the recording should end. While you are holding down the [REC] button, the following recording method select screen appears. A B NO C YES D Starting methods: Norm (Normal) — The existing data will be erased after re-recording starts. Key On — Data that exists prior to the point where you start playing a note will not be erased. 38 PF-500 NOTE When the starting method is set to “KeyOn,” you cannot change a voice or tempo (page 41) after the recording is complete. Recording Your Performance Ending methods: Replace – The data after the point you stop recording will also be erased. Punch Out — The data after the point you stop recording will remain. 3-2 Keep holding down the [REC] button and press the [TRACK 1] button. TIP If you cancel recording by pressing the [REC] button, recording stops when you press the button. If you cancel recording by pressing the [TOP] button, the PF500 locates the top of the song. The [TRACK 1] indicator flashes in red. (To stop recording, press the [REC] button again or press the [TOP] button.) Follow the procedure beginning with Step 4 on page 36. Recording to [TRACK2] This section explains how to record another part on the second track. 1 2 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT Procedure 1. 2. Select a voice. Select a voice (or voices) for recording. Repeat Step 2 on page 36. Enter record mode and select a recording track. Press and hold down the [REC] button and press the [TRACK 2] button. The [TRACK 2] indicator flashes in red. (To cancel recording, press the [REC] or [TOP] button.) TIP Pressing the [TRACK 1] button repeatedly toggles between playback on (the indicator lights up in green) and off (the indicator turns off). Make the recording by following the procedure beginning with Step 4 on page 36. You can record a new part while listening to playback of the recorded [TRACK 1] data. PF-500 39 Recording Your Performance Recording to the third or more tracks [EXTRA TRACKS] You can continue recording other parts into tracks 3–16 [EXTRA TRACKS] one by one. Procedure 1. Hold down the [REC] button in step 2 in the “Recording to [TRACK2]” on page 39 and use the B [–]/[+] buttons to select a recording track (3–16). select a recording track (3-16) A B NO C 2. YES D While holding down the [REC] key, press the [EXTRA TRACKS] button. Then, follow the procedure beginning with Step 4 on page 36. Other recording techniques Adding data to or recording over an existing song The previous section explains how to record your performance from the beginning by selecting a blank “P000: NewSong.” You can also add your performance to or overwrite existing songs (such as 50 preset piano songs [P-001—P-050], or your old recorded performances [see page 43]). Procedure 1. Select a song for recording (P-001 – P-050). Select one of the preset songs (P-001–P-050) instead of “P-000: NewSong” as described in Step 1 of “Recording to [TRACK1]” on page 35. To select a song from already-recorded data, see Steps 1 and 2 on page 48. NOTE If you record on a track that already has data, the existing data on the track will be lost. To continue recording, follow the procedure described in “Recording a New Song” from page 35 to 40. 40 PF-500 Recording Your Performance Changing a voice or tempo after recording You can change the voice and tempo after recording to change a song’s feel or to set a more suitable tempo. You can also change these elements in the middle of a song. Procedure 1. 2. 3. 4. Select a song you wish to change by using the SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons. To change the voice or tempo in the middle of the song, specify the measure to change using the B [–]/ [+] buttons. Change the settings (voice, reverb, etc.). For example, if you wish to change the recorded E.Piano1 voice to E. Piano2, use the voice group buttons and the A [–]/[+] buttons to select E.Piano2. When the setting is complete, press one of the SONG SELECT [ ] [ ] buttons once to return to the song select screen. Press and hold down the [REC] button and select the track to change. The indicator for the selected track lights up in red. Change the tempo setting now, if necessary. At this point, do not play the keyboard or press the SONG [START/ STOP] button. Otherwise, recording will start, erasing the recorded data. 5. NOTE When the starting method is set to “KeyOn,” you cannot change a voice or tempo (page 38) after the recording is complete. TIP Refer to “Questions about Operations and Functions” on page 90 for information on the settings that can be changed here. TIP Change the tempo in Step 4. CAUTION The edited settings (except for the tempo setting) will be saved in memory and you will not be able to restore the previous settings. Proceed with caution. Press the [TOP] or [REC] button to exit record mode. PF-500 41 Recording Your Performance Adjusting the volume balance between playback and your performance [SONG BALANCE] While recording multiple parts into tracks one by one, you can adjust the volume balance between the playback of the recorded parts and your current performance. Procedure 1. Move [SONG BALANCE] to the left or right to make adjustments. SONG The song playback volume will be lower. KEYBOARD SONG BALANCE TIP The song balance setting is also used during playback. (See page 48.) Your playing volume will be lower. Recording in Dual or Split mode When you record in Dual or Split mode, the PF-500 records each voice onto a separate track. The following table shows how tracks are assigned to each voice. CAUTION When you record multiple parts into tracks one by one, or when you record new data over an existing song (see page 40), the existing data will be erased. Proceed with caution. In the following example, Tracks 1, 2, and EXTRA TRACKn have been selected for recording. Tracks assigned for recording Tracks used for recording Dual Split TRACK1 TRACK2 EXTRA TRACKn TRACK1 TRACK2 EXTRA TRACKn TRACK1 TRACK2 EXTRA TRACKn ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ ↓ MAIN (voice 1) TRACK1 TRACK2 TRACKn LEFT (voice 1) – MAIN (voice 2) TRACK3 LEFT (voice 2) – TRACK4 TRACKn +2 TRACK1 TRACKn TRACK1 TRACKn TRACK2 TRACKn+1 TRACK2 TRACKn +1 – TRACK3 TRACKn +2 – TRACK4 TRACKn +3 Note: TRACKn = TRACK 3 – TRACK 16 If “n+1,” “n+2,” and “n+3” exceed 16, TRACKs 1, 2, and 3 are used. TIP Switching between Dual and Split mode in a song is not recorded. 42 PF-500 Split+Dual Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE] File screens (accessed via the [FILE] button) enables you to handle song files (e.g., save, delete, and rename recorded songs), and change the characters on the screen. The following parameters are provided for these operations: Settings Parameter name Reference page Saves recorded and other songs in PF-500 memory SaveToMemory 45 Deletes a song from PF-500 memory DeleteSong 46 Changes the title of songs RenameSongs 47 Change the type of characters on the screen CharacterCode 47 TERMINOLOGY File A file contains a group of data. On the PF-500, a song file includes song data and a song number. Memory Memory is a location inside the PF-500 in which you can save and edit data. Character code Type of characters PF-500 memory The PF-500 has the following three types of memory: • Current memory: This is a temporary memory area where you can temporarily place and edit the currently-selected song before playback or recording. • Preset song memory: This read-only memory area saves 50 piano preset songs. • Storage memory: This memory area enables you to save recorded songs. When you select a song in the song select screen, it is loaded from Preset song memory or Storage memory into Current memory. You will use Current memory to play back and record songs. When you turn off the power to the PF-500, songs saved in Preset song memory and Storage memory are not erased. On the other hand, songs in Current memory are lost. If you wish to keep a song in Current memory, you must save it in Storage memory (see pages 45). In this manual, a song located in a song recorded in Current memory, is referred to as a “Current song” and a song in Storage memory is a “Memory song.” Preset song memory Storage memory Current memory TRACK 1 SONG SELECT SONG TOP TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING DOWN A B C D CONTRAST UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG TEMPO VOICE EFFECT PF-500 PF-500 43 Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE] Basic file operation A message (information or confirmation dialog) sometimes appears on the screen to facilitate operation. Refer to the “Message List” on page 86 for an explanation of each message, appropriate actions to take. 2 3 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD 3 METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE 4 5 Procedure 1. Select a song. 2. Access the File menu. Select a song you wish to save or rename. Press the [FILE] button. A B NO C YES D To close the File menu, press the [EXIT] button once or twice. 44 3. Select the desired parameter. 4. Set the parameter or execute the command. 5. Close the File menu. PF-500 Press the [FILE] or A [–]/[+] buttons repeatedly to display the desired item from the following: “SaveToMemory”, “DeleteSong”, “RenameSong”, “CharacterCode”. Use the B [– (NO)]/[+ (YES)], C [–]/[+], D [–]/[+] buttons. For more information regarding this procedure, refer to the corresponding section below. Press the [EXIT] button. EFFECT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE] Saving recorded or other songs to PF-500 Storage memory...[SaveToMemory] If you record a song, then turn off the power to the PF-500, the song will be erased. To save the recorded song, you must save it into the PF-500 Storage memory. You can also save the preset songs, and additional or overwriting recordings (page 40) to Storage memory. A B NO C YES D Procedure See page 44 the basic operation information. The following is a detailed procedure of Step 4. 4-1 Name the song. To move the cursor (a small underline), use the C [–]/[+] buttons. To insert a space, press the C [–]/[+] buttons simultaneously. To select a character on the cursor, use the D [–]/[+] buttons. To delete a character, press the D [–]/[+] buttons simultaneously. You can use up to 58 characters for a song name. If the name is longer than the screen, use the C [–]/[+] buttons to move the cursor and scroll the name. 4-2 Execute the operation. Press the B [+ (YES)] button located next to “Execute?→”. “Sure?→” appears on the screen. Press the B [+ (YES)] button again to confirm the operation. (To cancel the operation, press the B [– (NO)] button.) The PF-500 displays “Executing” on the screen during the operation. When the operation is complete, “Completed” appears. The song is automatically numbered as “M—,” where “M” means “Memory” and “—” is a number. TIP If Storage memory contains one or more songs, and you save a new song, the PF-500 automatically sorts the songs alphabetically and renumbers them. TIP • You can change the type of characters on the screen using the CharacterCode parameter. • When you select a saved song later, the name with an extension “.MID” will appear. TERMINOLOGY “Execute?→”: Do you wish to execute the operation? “Sure?→”: Are you sure? “Executing”: The PF-500 is executing the operation. “Completed”: The operation is complete. CAUTION Do not turn off the power while the screen displays “Executing.” PF-500 45 Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE] Deleting a Memory song...[DeleteSong] This deletes a song from memory. You cannot delete a preset song or the current song. A B NO C YES D TIP To delete a Current song, select “ALL” for the ChannelClear parameter in the “SONG SETTING” menu (page 66). Alternatively, press the SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons simultaneously to display “Song Changed Save?”. This means “A song has been edited. Do you wish to save the change?” Press the B [– (NO)] button. The Current song is deleted and a blank “NewSong” is selected. Procedure See page 44 for basic operation information. The following is a detailed procedure of Step 4. 4-1 Select a song to delete. Use the C [–]/[+] buttons to select a song. 4-2 Execute the operation. Press the B [+ (YES)] button located next to “Execute?→.” Follow the instructions on screen. TIP Deleting a Memory song does not erase song data from Current memory. However, if you return to the song select screen, song information other than the song name is replaced by “--------------”. TIP After you delete a song, the PF-500 automatically updates the song numbers. CAUTION Never turn off the power while [Executing] is displayed. 46 PF-500 Saving Recorded Songs and Handling the Files...[FILE] Renaming a song...[RenameSong] You can change a song’s title except for the preset songs and [P-000: NewSong]. A B NO C YES D Procedure See page 44 for basic operation information. The following is a detailed procedure for Step 4. 4. Name the song as described in the [SaveToMemory] section (page 45). CAUTION Do not turn off the power while the screen displays “Executing.” TIP After you rename a song, the PF-500 sorts songs alphabetically and renumbers them. Changing the type of characters on screen...[CharacterCode] You can change the type of characters that appear on screen. The default setting is “International.” To input katakana, change this setting to “Japanese.” A B NO C YES D Options: International, Japanese Character list [International] [Japanese] PF-500 47 Playing Back Recorded Songs TIP Change the PF-500’s character type ([CharacterCord]) as appropriate for the selected song. You can play back songs recorded using the Record function (page 35). You can also play the keyboard along with the playback. TIP Songs containing a large amount of data may not be able to be read properly by the instrument, and as such you may not be able to select them. The maximum capacity is about 200–300KB, however this may differ depending on the data contents of each song. Playing back a song TEMPO [DOWN] [UP] 1 2-2 SONG SELECT SONG 2-1 TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE SYNCHRO START DEMO SONG 43 [SONG BALANCE] C D TEMPO VOICE 2-2 EFFECT 5 Procedure 1. Display the song select screen. Press either the SONG SELECT [ ]/[ ] buttons. Song select screen A B NO C 2. 2-1 YES D Select the desired song. Use the A [–]/[+] buttons to select the song type: “PresetSong” or “MemorySong.” If the internal Storage memory contains one or more songs, the PF500 displays “MemorySong.” 2-2 48 PF-500 Use the C [–]/[+] or SONG SELECT [ to select a song. TIP You can enjoy ensemble performance by yourself. Record the parts for a fourhanded song or a piano duet, then play the recorded part while playing the other part on the keyboard. ]/[ ] buttons TIP Use the SongRepeat parameter in the “SONG SETTING” menu (page 67) to select repeat playback of all songs or repeat playback of a single song. TIP If the song name extends beyond what can be displayed in the screen, you can press D [+] to move toward the right in steps of one character. Press D [–] to move back to the left in steps of one character. Playing Back Recorded Songs 3. Start playback. Press the SONG [START/STOP] button. Starting playback automatically as you start playing the keyboard (Synchro Start) You can start playback as soon as you start playing the keyboard. This is called the “Synchro Start” function. To enter Synchro Start standby mode, press and hold down the [TOP] button and press the SONG [START/STOP] button. The SONG [START/STOP] indicator flashes. Now play the keyboard. Playback starts simultaneously. To cancel the Synchro Start function, press the [TOP] button while the PF500 is in Synchro Start standby mode. You can move back and forth (rewind and fast forward) through the bars by using the B [–]/[+] buttons in the song select screen while the PF-500 is playing or stopped. The bar number in playback A B NO C YES ]/[ ] buttons to return to the song Adjusting the tempo You can use the TEMPO [DOWN]/[UP] buttons to adjust the playback tempo as required before or during playback. The default tempo (the song’s original tempo) is set when you press the [DOWN] and [UP] buttons simultaneously. Press either of the SONG SELECT [ select screen. 4. 5. TIP You can play the metronome along with the song playback. When you stop playback, the metronome is also stopped. D You can play the keyboard while the PF-500 is playing back a song. You can also play the notes in a voice different from the playback voice by selecting the voice from the panel, and adjusting the volume balance between the playback parts and your current performance using the [SONG BALANCE] slider. (See page 42.) Press either of the SONG SELECT [ select screen. TERMINOLOGY Bar: measure ]/[ ] buttons to return to the song TIP In the song select screen: • Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C[– ] button while playback is stopped in the middle of the song to locate the top of the song. • Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C[– ] button during playback to restart playback from the top of the song. • Press the SONG SELECT [ ] or the C[+] button during playback to start playback from the next song. Stop playback. When playback is complete, the PF-500 automatically stops and locates the top of the song. To stop playback in the middle of a song, press the [TOP] button. You can also pause playback by pressing the SONG [START/STOP] button. Playback stops when you press the button. Return to the main screen. Press the [EXIT] button. PF-500 49 Playing Back Recorded Songs Turning track playback on and off When you select a song on the PF-500, the indicators for tracks that contain data ([TRACK 1], [TRACK 2], [EXTRA TRACKS]) are lit in green. While the PF-500 is playing or stopped, pressing these track buttons turn off the indicators, and the data on those tracks will not be played. Pressing the track buttons toggles track playback on and off. You can play the part that is turned off. TIP You can practice a part or phrase using the FromToRepeat (page 66) and PhraseMark parameters (page 67) in the “SONG SETTING” menu. Supported song data type Data formats that can be played on the PF-500 The PF-500 plays song data in the following formats: Sequence format SMF (Standard MIDI File) formats 0 and 1 ESEQ TERMINOLOGY Sequence format: A structured method for recording performance data. Voice arrangement format XG voice arrangement GM system level 1 voice arrangement DOC voice arrangement TERMINOLOGY Voice arrangement format: A structured method for numbering the voices for assignment. See page 6 of the separate “Reference Booklet” for the XG voice list. Refer to “Data compatibility” on page 95 for more information on formats. 50 PF-500 Connections Connectors CAUTION Before connecting the PF-500 to other electronic components, turn off the power to all the components. Before turning the power on or off to all components, set all volume levels to minimum (0). Otherwise, electrical shock or damage to the components may occur. 2 1 AUX IN L/L+R AC INLET 3 PHONES AUX OUT R L/L+R PEDAL R POWER L LEVEL FIXED R ON MIDI AUX PEDAL HOST SELECT TO HOST OFF USB MIDI PC-2 Mac USB IN 4 5 OUT THRU 6 7 8 1 AUX IN [R], [L/L+R] jacks The stereo outputs from another instrument can be connected to these jacks, allowing the sound of an external instrument to be reproduced via the PF500’s speakers. Refer to the diagram below and use audio cables for connection. CAUTION When the PF-500’s AUX IN jacks are connected to an external device, first turn on the power to the external divice, then to the PF-500. Reverse this order when you turn the power off. PF-500 AUX IN L/L+R R AUX IN Plug shape depends on the divece. 9 TIP The PF-500’s [MASTER VOLUME] dial setting affects the input signal from the AUX IN jacks, but the [REVERB], [CHORUS], and BRILLIANCE [MELLOW] [BRIGHT] (page 28) settings do not. TIP If you connect the PF-500 to a monaural device, use only the AUX IN [L/L+R] jack or AUX OUT [L/L+R] jack. AUX OUT phone plug (standard) audio cable Tone Generator PF-500 51 Connections 2 AUX OUT [R][L] Pin jacks (LEVEL FIXED), [R][L/L+R] Phone jacks These jacks let you connect the PF-500 to your stereo system etc. to play at higher volumes, or connect a cassette recorder etc. to record your playing. Use audio cables to make connections as shown in the diagram. CAUTION When the PF-500’s AUX OUT jacks are connected to an external audio system, first turn on the power to the PF-500, then to the external audio system. Reverse this order when you turn the power off. Stereo AUX OUT L/L+R R L LEVEL FIXED R PF-500 phone plug (standard) To powered speakers When these are connected (with standard phone plugs), you can use the [MASTER VOLUME] control to adjust the volume of the sound output to the external device. AUX IN RCA pin plug RCA pin plug audio cable When these are connected (with RCA pin plug; LEVEL FIXED), the sound is output to the external device at a fixed level, regardless of the [MASTER VOLUME] control setting. 3 PHONES jack See page 16. 4 PEDAL jack See page 14. 5 AUX PEDAL jack A separately sold FC7 foot controller or FC4/FC5 foot switch can be connected to this jack. By using an FC7 you can control the volume while playing to add expression to your performance, or control various other functions. By using an FC4/FC5, you can switch various selected functions on/off. To select the function that will be controlled, use the [VOICE SETTING] parameter [AuxPedal] (See page 76). The SONG [START/STOP] function can also be assigned to a foot switch (See page 84). 6 MIDI [IN], [OUT], [THRU] connectors Use MIDI cables to connect external MIDI devices to these connectors. Make sure you set the HOST SELECT switch (described on the privious page) to MIDI when you use these connectors. 7 HOST SELECT switch This switch should be set according to the type of connected MIDI device or personal computer. (Refer to “Connecting a personal computer” on page 53 for more information.) 8 TO HOST jack This jack allows direct connection to a personal computer. (Refer to “Connecting a personal computer” on page 53 for more information.) 9 USB jack This jack allows direct connection to a personal computer. (Refer to “Connecting a personal computer” on page 53 for more information.) 52 PF-500 CAUTION Do not route the output from the AUX OUT jacks to the AUX IN jacks. That is, when you connect an external audio device to the AUX OUT jacks, do not connect the audio device to the PF500’s AUX IN jacks. If you make this connection, the signal input at the AUX IN jacks will be output from AUX OUT. This creates an audio loop, causing audio oscillation and abnormal playback, and leading to malfunction of both pieces of equipment. TIP Use audio cables and adaptor plugs with no resistance. TIP The PF-500’s [MASTER VOLUME] setting will not affect the sound that is output from AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED). TIP Connect or disconnect the pedal when the power is off. Connections Connecting a personal computer You can connect the [TO HOST], MIDI [IN][OUT][THRU], or [USB] connector of the PF-500 to your personal computer and enjoy using the PF-500 in conjunction with musical software on your computer. There are the three methods by which to connect the PF-500 to a personal computer: 1. Connecting the serial port on the computer to the PF-500’s TO HOST jack (page 52) 2. Using a MIDI interface and the PF-500’s MIDI connectors (page 52) 3. Connecting the USB port on the computer to the PF-500’s USB jack (page 52) For more information, refer to the following pages. TIP When connecting the PF-500 to a personal computer, first turn off the power to both the PF-500 and the computer before connecting any cables and setting the HOST SELECT switch. After making connections and switch settings, turn on the power to the computer first, then to the PF-500. TIP If you are not using the connection between the PF-500 and your computer, you must disconnect the cable from the [TO HOST] jack or [USB] jack. The PF-500 may not operate correctly if a cable is left connected. TIP The connectors that can be used will depend on the setting of the HOST SELECT switch. HOST SELECT switch setting Usable connectors [MIDI] [MIDI] connectors (all: [IN][OUT][THRU]) [PC-2], [Mac] [TO HOST] jack [USB] [USB] jack PF-500 53 Connections 1. Connecting the serial port on the computer to the PF-500’s TO HOST jack Connect the computer’s serial port (RS-232C or RS-422) to the PF-500’s TO HOST jack. In this connection, the PF-500 functions as a MIDI interface. Therefore, you do not need a special MIDI interface. Connection Use a special serial cable (page 55) to connect the computer’s serial port (RS-232C or RS-422) to the PF-500’s TO HOST jack. PF-500 TO HOST HOST SELECT MIDI PC-2 Mac USB TO HOST RS-232C (D-sub 9-pin) Windows RS-232C (D-sub 25-pin) Windows modem port Macintosh Note for Windows users (regarding the MIDI driver) To transfer data via the computer’s serial port and the PF-500’s TO HOST jack, you need to install a specific MIDI driver (the Yamaha CBX driver for Windows). You can download this driver from XG Library on the Yamaha Web site (http://www.yamaha-xg.com) or install from the Accessory CD-ROM included with the PF-500. 54 PF-500 Connections Type of serial cables and connection pin assignments According to the type of computer you connect, use one of the following serial cables. • Windows (with a serial port of D-sub 9-pin) mini DIN 1 2 8-pin 8 (CTS) 7 (RTS) 2 (RxD) 5 (GND) 3 4 8 5 • Macintosh System peripheral plug → 8-pin plug (Yamaha CCJ-MAC or equivalent) 8-pin mini DIN plug → D-sub 9-pin plug (Yamaha CCJ-PC2 or equivalent) D-sub 9-pin mini DIN 1 2 8-pin 3 4 5 6 7 8 3 (TxD) • Windows (with a serial port of D-sub 25-pin) 8-pin mini DIN plug → D-sub 25-pin plug (Yamaha CCJ-PC1NF or equivalent) 2 (HSK i) mini DIN 1 (HSK O) 8-pin 5 (RxD-) 4 (GND) 3 (TxD-) 8 (RxD+) 7 (GP-) 6 (TxD+) • Pin assignment The following diagram shows the pin assignments for each cable. Pin numbers (view from front) mini DIN 8-pin 1 2 3 4 8 5 5 (CTS) 4 (RTS) 3 (RxD) 7 (GND) D-sub 25-pin mini DIN 8-pin D-sub 25-pin D-sub 9-pin 6 7 8 3 4 5 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 5 4 3 2 1 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 9 8 7 6 2 (TxD) PF-500 HOST SELECT switch setting Set the PF-500 HOST SELECT switch properly according to the type of connected computer. • Macintosh: “Mac” (data transfer rate: 31,250bps, 1MHz clock) • Windows: “PC-2” (data transfer rate: 38,400bps) TIP If your system does not work properly with the connections and settings listed above, your software may require different settings. Check your software operation manual and set the HOST SELECT switch to the proper data transfer rate. PF-500 55 Connections 2. Using a MIDI interface and the PF-500’s MIDI connectors Connection Use a MIDI interface device to connect a computer to the PF-500 using special MIDI cables. PF-500 MIDI HOST SELECT MIDI PC-2 Mac USB IN OUT MIDI IN THRU MIDI OUT MIDI IN MIDI OUT MIDI OUT MIDI IN MIDI interface MIDI interface Windows Macintosh PF-500 HOST SELECT switch setting Set the PF-500 HOST SELECT switch to “MIDI.” 56 PF-500 Connections 3. Connecting the USB port on the computer to the PF-500’s USB jack If you connect the PF-500 to your computer, you can transfer MIDI data between your computer and the PF-500. You can also use the included File Utility (software for your computer) to transfer files between your computer and the internal memory of the PF-500. Connections Use a USB cable to connect the USB port on your computer to the [USB] jack on the PF-500. computer HOST SELECT TO HOST USB MIDI PC-2 Mac USB PF-500 TRACK 1 SONG SELECT SONG TOP TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING DOWN A B C D CONTRAST UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG TEMPO VOICE EFFECT USB cable TIP There are two types of USB connectors: A and B. The USB jack on the PF-500 accepts a B-type connector. Connect the A-type connector of the USB cable to the USB port on your computer. Connect the B-type connector to the USB jack on the PF-500. PF-500 HOST SELECT switch setting Set the PF-500 HOST SELECT switch to “USB.” About the USB driver You must install the specified USB driver (YAMAHA USB MIDI Driver) in your computer before you can transfer data between the computer and the PF-500. The YAMAHA USB MIDI Driver can be installed from the Accessory CD-ROM included with the PF-500. The YAMAHA USB MIDI Driver supports the following OS versions. Windows 98, Windows 98SE, Windows Me, Windows 2000, Windows XP Mac OS 8.6–9.2.1 PF-500 57 Connections About the USB connector • In order to use MIDI on your computer, you will need application software that is appropriate for your computer and that meets your needs. • If you want to use a USB cable to connect the PF-500 to your computer, you must connect the USB cable before turning on the power of the PF-500. Also, do not turn the power of the PF-500 on or off while application software that uses USB MIDI is running. • The PF-500 will begin transmission a short time after the USB connection is made. • If you are using Windows 2000, problems may occur on your computer when your computer starts up. In this case, turn on the power of the PF-500 when your computer is running. • When using a USB cable to connect the PF-500 to your computer, make the connection directly without passing through a USB hub. • Depending on the state of your computer, the operating state of the PF-500 may become unstable. Do not use your computer in a way that causes it to enter an unstable state. CAUTION • If you turn the power of the PF-500 on/off or connect/disconnect the USB cable in the following states, problems will occur in the computer system, possibly causing it to “freeze” (hang up), or causing the PF-500 to stop functioning. - While installing the driver - While starting-up or shutting-down the operating system - While your computer is suspended (sleeping) - While a MIDI application is running • Performing the following actions may cause your computer to hang up or the PF-500 to stop functioning. - Rapidly turning the power on/off or connecting/disconnecting the cable - Shifting to power-conservation (sleep) mode while MIDI data is being transferred, or returning from sleep mode - Connecting/disconnecting the cable while the power of the PF-500 is on - Turning the power of the PF-500 on/off, starting up your computer, or installing the driver while a large amount of data is being transferred 58 PF-500 Detailed Settings PF-500 59 Detailed Settings You can set various parameters to make the best use of PF-500 functions, such as fine tuning the pitch, selecting a voice for the metronome, repeating playback, etc. For the basic procedure to make these settings, refer to page 85. Parameter List The following parameters are available. Recording and playback [SONG SETTING] Settings Correcting note timing Specifying whether playback starts immediately along with the first voicing Auditioning the channels Deleting data by each channel Specifying the range and playing back repeatedly Playing back the phrase specified by the phrase number Playing back a song repeatedly Parameter name Reference page Quantize 65 QuickPlay 66 ChannelListen ChannelClear FromToRepeat 66 66 66 PhraseMark 67 SongRepeat 67 Metronome METRONOME [SETTING] Settings Metronome time signature Metronome volume level Metronome voice 60 PF-500 Parameter name TimeSignature MetronomeVolume MetronomeSound Reference page 68 68 68 Detailed Settings Voices [VOICE SETTING] In Dual mode, parameters with the “ *” mark are set for Voice 1 and Voice 2 individually. Settings Parameter name Reference page Octave* Volume level* Position of right and left channels* Fine pitch adjustment (only in Dual mode) Reverb type Reverb depth* Chorus type Chorus depth* Chorus on/off Select the DSP type* Set the speed of the vibraphone vibrato effect* Turn the vibraphone vibrato effect on/off* Adjust the speed of the rotary speaker* Adjust the DSP effect depth* Adjust the brightness of the sound* Adjust the resonance effect* Adjust the low-range frequency of the equalizer* Adjust the low-range gain (boost/cut) of the equalizer* Adjust the high-range frequency of the equalizer* Adjust the high-range gain (boost/cut) of the equalizer* Touch sensitivity* Right pedal function Center pedal function Left pedal function Auxiliary pedal function Octave Volume Pan Detune ReverbType ReverbSend ChorusType ChorusSend ChorusOnOff DSP Type (DSP) VibeRotorSpeed VibeRotorOnOff (RotorOnOff) RotarySpeed (Rot.Speed) DSPDepth Brightness HarmonicContent (Harmonic) EQ LowFreq. (EQ L.Freq) 70 70 70 70 71 71 71 71 72 72 72 73 73 73 73 73 74 EQ LowGain 74 EQ HighFreq. (EQ H.Freq) 74 EQ HighGain 74 TouchSense RPedal MPedal LPedal AuxPedal 75 75 75 76 76 PF-500 61 Detailed Settings MIDI [MIDI SETTING] Settings MIDI transmit channel Specify the MIDI receive channel Local control on/off Selecting performance from the keyboard or song data for MIDI transmission Type of data received via MIDI Type of data transmitted via MIDI Song data bulk dump Transmitting the initial settings Voice data bulk dump Parameter name Reference page MidiOutChannel MidiInChannel LocalControl 78 78 79 MidiOutSelect 79 ReceiveParameter TransmitParameter SongBulkDump InitialSetup VoiceBulkDump 79 79 80 80 80 [OTHER SETTING] Settings Selecting a touch response Make fine pitch adjustments Selecting a tuning curve for a piano voice Selecting a scale Specifying the Split Point Change the key Specify the depth of the Soft pedal Depth of string resonance Depth of sustain sampling for the damper pedal Specify the volume of the key-off sound Selecting a pedal function for vibraphone Assign the SONG [START/STOP] function to the pedal Selecting a type of auxiliary pedal Setting the point at which the damper pedal starts to affect the sound Pitch bend range Switch the speaker on/off Selecting the items saved at the time of shutdown Restoring the normal (default) settings 62 PF-500 Parameter name Reference page TouchResponse Tune PianoTuningCurve Scale SplitPoint Transpose SoftPedalDepth StringResonanceDepth SustainSamplingDepth KeyOffSamplingDepth VibraphonePedalMode 81 81 81 82 82 82 83 83 83 83 83 PedalStart/Srop 84 AuxPedalType 84 HalfPedalPoint 84 PitchBendRange Speaker MemoryBackUp FactorySet 84 85 85 85 Detailed Settings Making detailed settings 1 SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING 2 3 4 A CONTRAST B NO DOWN 1 YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING 1 SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START C SONG D TEMPO 1 VOICE 2 3 3 5 EFFECT 1 Procedure 1. Access a setting menu. Press the desired setting button ([SONG SETTING], METRONOME [SETTING], [VOICE SETTING], [MIDI SETTING], or [OTHER SETTING]) to access the corresponding setting menu. Press the [EXIT] button any time to close the setting menu. 2. 3. Select the desired parameter or part. Press the setting button, A [–]/[+], and/or C [–]/[+] buttons repeatedly as required. Set the parameter or part. Some parameters or parts lead you to more options. Use the B [– (NO)]/[+ (YES)], C [–]/[+], and D [–]/[+] buttons to select or set the option. To restore the normal parameter value, press the [–] and [+] buttons simultaneously. PF-500 63 Detailed Settings 4. Write, execute, or save the data. There are two ways to respond to the messages. If “Execute?→” or “Start?→” appears: Press the B [+(YES)] button to display confirmation ([Sure?→]). To proceed, press the B [+(YES)] button again. The PF-500 displays “Executing” and writes the data. When the operation is complete, it displays “Completed” for three seconds, then returns to the previous screen. To cancel the operation, press the B [–(NO)] button instead of the B [+(YES)] button. A B NO C YES D If “Set?→” appears: Press the B [+(YES)] button to execute the setting. The PF-500 displays “Executing” and saves the data. When the operation is complete, it displays “Completed” for three seconds, then returns to the previous screen. However, the “Completed” display that appears when [VoiceBulkDump] (page 80) is finished will not change back to the previous display after three seconds. Press any button on the panel to return to the previous display. A B NO C 5. 64 PF-500 Close the setting menu. Press the [EXIT] button. YES D Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING] You can make detailed settings for the selected song. First, select the desired song from preset songs (“PresetSong”) or memory songs (“MemorySong”) (see page 48). Procedure Select the desired song and press the [SONG SETTING] button to access the “Song Setting” menu. SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB MIDI SETTING CHORUS OTHER SETTING BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT [SONG SETTING] Correcting note timing [Quantize] Setting range: 0% - 100% You can correct the timing of notes. For example, you can adjust recorded notes to precise eighth or sixteenth notes, or make the entire feel of a song more lively (with a swing type of rhythm). • Changes are made by song. • You can also listen to the sound while changing the setting. To change the data, you need to respond to “Execute?→.” See the procedure on page 63. If you select “1/8” for correction: Performance data Swing rate = 50% : not swinging Swing rate = 75% (51% or higher) : The timing of even beat notes is slightly delayed. Stores the changed value. A B NO C YES Swing rate = 25% (49% or lower) : The timing of even beat notes is slightly early. D Specifies the type of note. Notes for which you can adjust the timing: Swing rate = 67% : The timing of the even beat notes is moved to the third beat of the triplets. 3 [OFF] [1/4] quarter note [1/8] eighth note 3 TIP Save the edited song data to memory. (See page 45.) 3 [1/12] eighth note triplets [1/16] sixteenth note 3 [1/24] sixteenth note triplets If you select “1/8” or “1/16” for correction, the PF500 displays “SwingRate=xx%”, which enables you to make the entire feel of a song more lively and swinging. PF-500 65 Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING] Specifying whether playback starts immediately along with the first voicing [QuickPlay] This parameter enables you to specify whether a song that starts from the middle of a bar, or a song with a silence prior to the first note, should be played from the first note or from the top of the bar (rest or blank). See the procedure on page 63. Deleting data from each channel [ChannelClear] You can delete data from each of 16 channels. See the procedure on page 63. Press this button to delete data. A B NO C A B NO YES D Use these buttons to select the desired channel for deletion. YES Setting range: C Ch1 - Ch16, ALL (all channels) D Setting range: [On] Playing from the first note [Off] Playing from the top of the bar (including a rest or blank) Auditioning the channels [ChannelListen] You can select a single channel to listen to its contents. Playback starts from the first note. See the procedure on page 63. Playback continues as long as you press and hold down this button. A B NO C YES D Use these buttons to select the desired channel for playback. Setting range: TIP • Channels that do not contain any data are not displayed. However, for some songs, all channels (including the channels that contain no data) may be displayed. • Save the edited song data to memory. (See page 45.) Specifying the range and playing back repeatedly [FromToRepeat] You can specify a range (in steps of beats) in a song to play back repeatedly. • Playback repeats after it reaches just prior to the beat specified as the end point. • If you start playing back a song with “Repeat On” selected, the count down starts, followed by the repeated playback of the specified part until you press the [TOP] button. • If you select “Repeat Off,” normal playback starts. See the procedure on page 63. Ch1 - Ch16 TIP Usually, channels that do not contain any data are not displayed. However, for some songs, all channels (including the channels that contain no data) may be displayed. Use these buttons to select “Repeat On.” A NO C Use these buttons to specify the start point of the repeated range. 66 PF-500 B YES D Use these buttons to specify the end point of the repeated range. Detailed settings for recording and playback [SONG SETTING] TIP Use the following buttons to specify the range to be repeated during song playback. C [–][+] ........ specifies the start point of the repeat. D [–]/[+] .......specifies the end point of the repeat. NOTE When you select another song, the specified range is automatically cancelled and the Repeat function is turned off. Playing back the phrase specified by the phrase number [PhraseMark] Playing back a song repeatedly [SongRepeat] You can repeatedly play back all songs or a single song selected from the 50 preset songs. • When you start playback, the PF-500 plays the song you selected using the front panel, then starts repeat playback of the specified songs until you press the [TOP] button. See the procedure on page 63. Use these buttons to select “On.” A B NO If you select a song that contains phrase mark data, you can specify phrase numbers in the score to play back from the mark point, or to play back the phrase repeatedly. • If you start playing back a song with “Repeat On” selected, the count down starts, followed by the repeated playback of the specified phrase until you press the [TOP] button. • If you select “Repeat Off,” normal playback starts from the specified phrase. See the procedure on page 63. Use these buttons to select “Repeat On.” A D Use these buttons to specify the repeated songs. Setting range: [MemorySongs] All songs in the PF-500’s memory [PresetSongs] All 50 preset songs [ALL] All songs from “MemorySongs” and “PresetSongs” [OneSong] One song selected from the front panel B NO C C YES YES D Use these buttons to specify the phrase number. Setting range of the phrase number: Off (not specified) 1 - the last phrase number of the song If you select a song that dose not contain phrase mark data, you can select only “Off.” PF-500 67 Detailed settings for the metronome METRONOME [SETTING] You can set the time signature, volume level, and voice of the PF-500 metronome. Procedure Press the [METRONOME SETTING] button to access the Metronome Setting menu. [METRONOME SETTING] SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C VOICE Setting the metronome time signature [TimeSignature] See the procedure on page 63. Selecting the metronome voice [MetronomeSound] A B NO C NO C Use these buttons to set the denominator of the time signature. For example, to specify “3/4,” use the C [–]/[+] buttons to select “3” and the D [–]/[+] buttons to select “4.” 1 - 16 [BellOff] [EnglishVoice] [GermanVoice] [JapaneseVoice] [FrenchVoice] [SpanishVoice] [BellOn] Setting options for the denominator: 2, 4, and 8 See the procedure on page 63. A B NO 0-127 68 PF-500 YES D D Click (standard metronome sound) Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in English Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in German Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in Japanese Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in French Click and “1, 2, 3, 4” in Spanish Click and bell TIP To mute the beat count, select “BellOff.” Setting the metronome volume level [MetronomeVolume] YES Setting range: Setting range for the numerator: Setting range: B YES D C EFFECT See the procedure on page 63. A Use these buttons to set the numerator of the time signature. D TEMPO Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] This menu enables you to make various detailed settings for the voices in Dual or Split mode and the effects. You can make these settings for each voice (or each combination of voices) individually. You can listen to the notes you play on the keyboard while changing the settings. Procedure 1. Select a voice and press the [VOICE SETTING] button to access the “Voice Setting” menu. [VOICE SETTING] SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING EXIT MIN 2. NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO VOICE EFFECT Press the A [–]/[+] buttons to select the part for which you wish to change the voice. The range of the displayed part varies depending on the selected voice. [Main] [Main × Layer] [Left] [Left × Layer] MAIN voices (displayed with a single voice or in Split mode) MAIN Voice 1 and Voice 2 (displayed when the MAIN side is in Dual mode) LEFT voice (displayed in Split mode) LEFT Voice 1 and Voice 2 (displayed when the LEFT side is in Dual mode) PF-500 69 Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] TIP In Dual mode, parameters with the “*” mark are set for Voice 1 and Voice 2 individually. TIP Parameter names enclosed in parentheses ( ) are displayed in Dual mode. Setting the octave [Octave]* Setting the position of right and left channels [Pan]* You can specify the position in the stereo image from which you hear the sound. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO The pitch of a note can be shifted upward or downward in steps of an octave. See the procedure on page 63. A C YES D In Dual mode: B A NO B YES NO C D C D Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2) In Dual mode: A Setting range: B NO C YES L64 (hard left) - C (center) - R63 (hard right) D Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2) Setting range: –2 (two octaves lower) - 0 (no pitch shift) - +2 (two octaves higher) Make fine adjustments to the pitch (only in Dual mode) [Detune] The pitch of the two sounds selected in Dual mode can be “skewed” slightly away from each other. See the procedure on page 63. Setting the volume level [Volume]* A You can set the volume level for each voice part. See the procedure on page 63. C YES D A B NO C YES D Voice for editing (Voice 1 and Voice 2) Setting range: Setting range: –20–+20 (Positive (+) settings will raise the pitch of the first sound and lower the pitch of the second sound. Negative (–) settings will do the opposite.) D In Dual mode: PF-500 YES B NO 70 B NO C A 0 - 127 YES Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] Selecting the reverb type [ReverbType] Selecting the chorus type [Chorus Type] TIP You cannot set this parameter for the voice parts “Left” and “LeftXLayer.” TIP You cannot set this parameter for the voice parts “Left” and “Left × Layer.” See the procedure on page 63. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C A B YES NO D C YES D Setting range: Setting range: Room Simulates reverberation in a room. Hall1 Simulates reverberation in a concert hall. Hall2 Reverberation is slightly longer than that of “Hall1.” Stage Reverberation suitable for a solo instrument sound. Plate Reverberation from the vibration of a metal plate. Chorus Celeste Flanger Adds a rich, spacious sound. Adds swell and a spacious sound. Adds swell effects of an ascending or descending jet plane. Setting the chorus depth [ChorusSend]* See the procedure on page 63. Setting the reverb depth [ReverbSend]* A B NO TIP The reverb effect is not applied if the ReverbSend parameter is set to “0.” C YES D In Dual mode: See the procedure on page 63. A B NO A YES B NO YES C D Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2) C D Setting range: In Dual mode: 0 - 127 A B NO C YES D Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2) Setting range: 0 - 127 PF-500 71 Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] AutoPan Setting the chorus on/off [ChorusOnOff] You can set the [CHORUS] button on or off for each voice. When you select a voice, the chorus on/ off setting for the voice automatically changes according to this parameter. TIP Even if this parameter is turned on, the chorus effect is disabled if the ChorusSend parameter is set to 0. Setting the speed of the vibraphone vibrato effect* [VibeRotorSpeed] See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C The sound pans left to right and back and forth. Phaser The phase changes periodically, swelling the sound. AutoWah The center frequency of the wah filter changes periodically. SoundBoardRev Simulates the reverberation of a piano soundboard. Off No effect. YES TERMINOLOGY Rotor= The rotating portion of an electrical device etc. D This will be displayed only if VibeRotor is selected for the DSP Type parameter explained above. This sets the speed of the vibrato effect that is applied when you have selected Vibraphone and are using the VibeRotor pedal. See the procedure on page 63. Setting range: On/Off Selecting the DSP type* [DSP Type (DSP)] You can select other effects (than reverb and chorus). See the procedure on page 63. A B Setting range: NO C YES D Setting range: DelayLCR DelayLR Echo CrossDelay Symphonic RotarySpeaker Tremolo VibeRotor 72 PF-500 Delay applied at left, center, and right positions. Delay applied at left and right positions. Echo-like delay Left and right delays are crossed. Adds a rich and deep acoustic effect. Adds the vibrato effect of a rotary speaker. The volume level changes in rapid cycles. The vibrato effect of a vibraphone. 1–10 Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] Turning the vibraphone vibrato effect on/off* [VibeRotorOnOff (RotorOnOff)] Adjusting the brightness of the sound* [Brightness] See the procedure on page 63. This will be displayed only if VibeRotor is selected for the DSP Type parameter explained above. It turns on/off the vibrato effect that is applied when you use the VibeRotor pedal. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C Setting range: YES D Setting range: On/Off Setting the rotation speed of the rotary speaker* [RotarySpeed (Rot.Speed)] –64–+63 Adjusting the resonance effect* [HarmonicContent (Harmonic)] TERMINOLOGY Resonance= Sympathetic vibration See the procedure on page 63. This will be displayed only if RotarySpeaker is selected for the DSP Type parameter explained above. It sets the rotation speed of the rotary speaker effect. See the procedure on page 63. Setting range: –64–+63 Setting range: Slow/Fast Adjusting the depth of the DSP effect* [DSPDepth] This sets the depth of the DSP effect (page 72). Some DSP Type settings do not allow you to set the DSPDepth. See the procedure on page 63. Setting range: 1 (output only the original sound with almost no effect applied)–127 (output only the sound processed by the effect) PF-500 73 Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] Adjusting the low-range frequency of the equalizer* [EQ LowFreq. (EQ L.Freq)] Adjusting the high-range frequency of the equalizer* [EQ HighFreq. (EQ H.Freq)] TERMINOLOGY Equalizer: An audio equalizer divides the frequency spectrum into multiple regions and enables the user to adjust the relative amplitude of each region. See the procedure on page 63. Setting range: High Gain Low Gain 500 Hz–16.0 kHz Adjusting the high-range gain (amount of boost/cut) of the equalizer* [EQ HighGain] See the procedure on page 63. Low Freq. High Freq. A See the procedure on page 63. NO C Setting range: –12–+12 dB Setting range: 32 Hz–2.0 kHz Adjusting the low-range gain (amount of boost/cut) of the equalizer* [EQ LowGain] See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C Setting range: –12–+12 dB 74 PF-500 B YES D YES D Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] Setting the touch sensitivity [TouchSense]* Setting the right pedal function [RPedal] This parameter enables determines the manner and degree to which the volume level changes in response to your touch on the keyboard (how hard you play). Since the volume level of the harpsichords and pipe organs do not change regardless of how you play the keyboard, the normal setting for these voices is 127. (See the setting range below.) See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C YES D In Dual mode: A B NO C YES D Voice for editing (Voice 1 or Voice 2) Setting range: 0 (softest) - 64 (largest changes in the level) - 127 (loudest and fixed) See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C YES D Setting range: Sustain SustainCont ON/OFF switch type damper Damper that sustains the sound proportionately to how deeply you press the pedal Sostenuto Sostenuto (page 27) Soft Soft (page 27) Expression A function that lets you create changes in dynamics (volume) as you play PitchBend Up A function that smoothly raises the pitch PitchBend Down A function that smoothly lowers the pitch RotarySpeed Change the rotational speed of the JazzOrgan rotary speaker (switch between fast/slow each time you press the pedal) Viberotor Switch the vibraphone vibrato on/off (switch on/off each time you press the pedal) Off No function Normal setting: SustainCont Setting the center pedal function [MPedal] See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C YES D Setting range: Same as “Specifying the function of the right pedal,” above. Normal Setting: Sostenuto PF-500 75 Detailed settings for the voices [VOICE SETTING] Setting the left pedal function [LPedal] See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C YES D Setting range: Same as “Right pedal function assignment” (page 75). Normal Setting: Soft (for all voices other than JazzOrgan and VibraPhone) Rotary Speed (JazzOrgan), Vibraphone (VibeRotor) Setting the auxiliary pedal function [AuxPedal] You can assign a function to the pedal connected to the PF-500’s AUX PEDAL jack. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C YES D Setting range: Same as “Right pedal function assignment” (page 75). Normal setting: Expression TIP YAMAHA FC7 foot controller This foot controller is suitable for controlling Expression, SustainCont, or PitchBend Up/Down. YAMAHA FC4 foot switch YAMAHA FC5 foot switch These foot switches are suitable for controlling Sustain, Sostenuto, Soft, RotarySpeed, or VibeRotor. 76 PF-500 MIDI [MIDI SETTING] You can make detailed MIDI settings, such as setting up MIDI transmit/receive channels. About MIDI MIDI (Musical Instrument Digital Interface) is a standard format for data transmission/reception. It enables the transfer of performance data and commands between MIDI devices and personal computers. Using MIDI, you can control a connected MIDI device from the PF-500, or control the PF-500 from a connected MIDI device or computer. MIDI connectors MIDI HOST SELECT MIDI PC-2 Mac USB IN OUT THRU MIDI [IN]: Receives MIDI data. MIDI [OUT]: Transmits MIDI data. MIDI [THRU]: Transmits data received at the MIDI [IN] connector as it is. TIP Prepare dedicated MIDI cables. [TO HOST] connector Use this connector to connect the PF-500 to a computer. HOST SELECT TO HOST MIDI PC-2 Mac USB TIP The type connecting cable varies depending on the computer. Refer to “Connecting a Personal Computer” on page 53 for more information. [USB] connector Use this connector to connect the PF-500 and computer. HOST SELECT MIDI PC-2 Mac USB TO HOST USB TIP MIDI performance data and commands are transferred in the form of numeric values. Since MIDI data that can be transmitted or received varies depending on the type of MIDI device, check the “MIDI Implementation Chart” to find out what MIDI data and commands your devices can transmit or receive. The PF500’s MIDI Implementation Chart is listed on page 32 in the “Reference Booklet” for the PF-500. When you are using the MIDI connectors, set the [HOST SELECT] switch to “MIDI.” (See page 52.) TIP When you are using the [TO HOST] connector, set the [HOST SELECT] switch correctly, according to the type of computer you are using. (See page 52.) NOTE When you are using the [USB] connector, set the [HOST SELECT] switch to “USB.” TIP You can also obtain detailed information about MIDI from various music magazines and books. PF-500 77 MIDI [MIDI SETTING] Procedure Press the [MIDI SETTING] button to enter MIDI setting mode. [MIDI SETTING] SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB MIDI SETTING CHORUS OTHER SETTING BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE SYNCHRO START DEMO SONG C D TEMPO EFFECT VOICE Setting the MIDI transmit channel [MidiOutChannel] Setting the MIDI receive channel [MidiInChannel] This parameter enables you to specify the channel on which the PF-500 transmits MIDI data. See the procedure on page 63. A You can specify whether each channel of data from MIDI [IN], [TO HOST], and [USB] will be received. See the procedure on page 63. B A NO B YES NO C D C Select a voice part. Specify the channel. Setting for: Main, Left, Layer, Left Layer Setting range: Ch1 - Ch16, Off (Not transmitted.) Normal setting: Main — Ch1 Left — Ch2 Layer — Ch3 Left Layer— Ch4 YES D Select a channel. Select a MIDI receive part. Setting for: Ch1 - Ch32 Setting range: Song, Main, Left, Layer, LeftLayer, Keyboard, Off Normal setting: Ch1–16 Ch17 Ch18 Ch19 Ch20 Ch21 Others — — — — — — — Song Keyboard Main Left Layer LeftLayer Off MIDI data MIDI IN TO HOST USB (When the channel setting is other than Song or Off) Port A 78 PF-500 Port B Sound source A Channels 1-16 Sound source B Channels 17-32 Used for song playback Only for song playback Played from the keyboard MIDI [MIDI SETTING] Setting Local control on/off [LocalControl] “Local Control On” is a state in which the PF-500 produces the sound from its tone generator when you play the keyboard. In “Local Control Off ” state, the keyboard and the tone generator are cut off from each other. This means that even if you play the keyboard, the PF-500 will not produce the sound. Instead, the keyboard data can be transmitted via MIDI to a connected MIDI device, which can produce the sound. The “Local Control Off ” setting is useful when you wish to play an external sound source while playing the keys on the PF-500. See the procedure on page 63. A C This parameter enables you to specify which MIDI data the PF-500 can receive. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C Select a type of data. YES D Select On or Off. Type of data: Note, Control, Program, Pitch Bend, SysEx (System Exclusive) B NO Selecting a type of data received via MIDI [ReceiveParameter] YES Setting range: On/Off D Normal setting: On for all types of data Setting range: On/Off Normal setting: On Selecting performance from the keyboard or song data for MIDI transmission [MidiOutSelect] You can select whether your performance data or song playback data (including demo songs) is sent via MIDI. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C Selecting a type of data transmitted via MIDI [TransmitParameter] This parameter enables you to specify which MIDI data the PF-500 can transmit. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C Select a type of data. YES D Select On or Off. Type of data: YES Note, Control, Program, Pitch Bend, SystemRealTime, SysEx (System Exclusive) D Setting range: Setting range: On/Off Keyboard performance data played on the keyboard Song song playback data Normal setting: On for all types of data Normal setting: Keyboard PF-500 79 MIDI [MIDI SETTING] Transmitting the initial settings on the panel [InitialSetup] You can transmit the panel data, such as voice selection, to a connected sequencer. Before you record performance data to a connected MDF3 or sequencer, it is useful if you first send and record (at the beginning of the performance data) the panel setup data for your performance during playback. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C YES D Executing voice data bulk dump [VoiceBulkDump] You can transmit the voice data specified in the “Voice Setting” menu (page 69) as MIDI bulk data. You can interrupt voice data bulk dump transmission by pressing the B [– (NO)] button. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C 80 PF-500 YES D Other settings You can make detailed settings for touch, tuning, scale, etc. Procedure Press the [OTHER SETTING] button to enter Other Setting mode. SONG SELECT SONG TRACK 1 TRACK 2 EXTRA TRACKS FILE TOP START/STOP REC SONG SETTING KEYBOARD METRONOME START/STOP SETTING A CONTRAST B NO DOWN YES UP GRAND PIANO 1 GRAND PIANO 2 E.PIANO 1 E.PIANO 2 HARPSICHORD E.CLAVICHORD VIBRAPHONE GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN JAZZ ORGAN STRINGS CHOIR SYNTH. PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS XG VOICE SETTING SPLIT VARIATION REVERB CHORUS MIDI SETTING OTHER SETTING BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT EXIT MIN NEW SONG MAX MASTER VOLUME SONG BALANCE DEMO SYNCHRO START SONG C D TEMPO EFFECT VOICE [OTHER SETTING] Selecting a touch response [TouchResponse] Fine tuning the pitch [Tune] You can specify a touch response (how the sound responds to the way you play the keys). See the procedure on page 63. You can fine tune the pitch of the entire instrument. This function is useful when you play the PF-500 along with other instruments or CD music. See the procedure on page 63. A A B B NO NO C C YES YES D D Setting range: Light With a soft touch, the PF-500 produces a loud sound. The volume level of tones tends to be consistent. Medium Standard touch response. Heavy You must hit the key very hard to generate a loud volume. This allows for versatile expression, from pianissimo to fortissimo tones. Fixed No touch response. The volume level will be the same regardless of how hard you play the keys. Use the B [–]/[+] buttons to set the volume level. Setting range: A3=427.0Hz - 453.0Hz (0.1Hz steps) Selecting a tuning curve for a piano voice [PianoTuningCurve] You can select a tuning curve from “GrandPiano1” and “GrandPiano2.” Select “Flat” if you feel the tuning curve of the piano voice does not quite match that of other instruments voices. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO YES Setting range of the “Fixed” volume level: 1 - 127 C D Setting range: Stretch Flat Tuning curve particularly for pianos Tuning curve in which the frequency is octave doubled over the entire keyboard range PF-500 81 Other settings Selecting a scale [Scale] A You can select various scales. Equal Temperament is the most common contemporary piano tuning scale. However, history has known numerous other scales, many of which serve as the basis for certain genres of music. You can experience the tunings of these genres. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C NO C D Equal One octave is divided into twelve equal intervals. Currently most popular piano tuning scale. PureMajor/PureMinor Based on natural overtones, three major chords using these scales produce a beautiful, pure sound. They are sometimes used for chorus parts. Pythagorean This scale, designed by Pythagoras, a Greek philosopher, is based on the interval of a perfect 5th. The 3rd produces swells, but the 4th and 5th are beautiful and suitable for some leads. MeanTone This scale is an improvement of the Pythagorean in that the swell of the 3rd has been eliminated. It spread during the late 16th century through the late 18th century. Handel used this scale. WerckMeister/KirnBerger These scales combine Mean Tone and Pythagorean in different ways. With these scales, modulation changes the impression and feel of the songs. They were often used in the era of Bach and Beethoven. They are also often used now to reproduce the music of that era on harpsichords. Normal setting: Equal If you select a scale other than Equal, you need to specify the root note using the B [–]/[+] buttons. D      C, C , D, E , E, F, F , G, A , A, B , B Setting range: Specifying the Split Point [SplitPoint] You can specify the split point (the boundary between the right-hand and left-hand keyboard areas). See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C YES D Setting range: A-1–C7 NOTE You can also use [SPLIT] to set the split point. (page 33) Changing the key [Transpose] TIP TRANSPOSE= To change the key (Changing the key: To raise or lower the overall pitch of the entire song.) The PF-500’s Transpose function makes it possible to shift the pitch of the entire keyboard up or down in semitone intervals to facilitate playing in difficult key signatures, and to let you easily match the pitch of the keyboard to the range of a singer or other instruments. For example, if you set the transposition amount to “5,” playing key C produces pitch F. In this way, you can play the song as if it were in C major, and the PF-500 will transpose it to the key of F. Setting for: Master Keyboard Song PF-500 YES YES Setting range: 82 B The sound of the entire instrument (the manually-played sound and the song playback) The manually-played sound The song playback Other settings Setting range: –12 (–1 octave)–0 (normal pitch)–+12 (+1 octave) Adjusting the depth of the Soft pedal [SoftPedalDepth] Specify the volume of the keyoff sound [KeyOffSamplingDepth] You can adjust the volume of the key-off sound (the subtle sound that occurs when you release a key) This is effective on the voice groups “Grand Piano1,” “Harpsichord,” and “E.Clavichord” and on the voice “E.Piano2.” See the procedure on page 63. See the procedure on page 63. Setting range: 1–10 Setting range: Depth of string resonance [StringResonanceDepth] Off, 1 - 10 This parameter is effective on the voices, such as “Grand Piano 1.” See the procedure on page 63. A Selecting a pedal function for vibraphone [VibraphonePedalMode] B NO C YES D Setting range: Off, 1 - 10 This parameter enables you to select whether the sound is sustained while you press the keys on the keyboard (“PianoLike”) or the sound is sustained only while you press and hold down the sustain pedal, like playing a real vibraphone (“Normal”). See the procedure on page 63. A Depth of sustain sampling for the damper pedal [SustainSamplingDepth] This parameter is effective only on the voice group “GRANDPIANO1.” See the procedure on page 63. A NO C YES D Setting range: PianoLike, Normal Normal setting: PianoLike B NO C B YES D Setting range: Off, 1 - 10 PF-500 83 Other settings Assign the SONG [START/ STOP] function to the pedal [PedalStart/Stop] Setting the point at which the damper pedal starts to affect the sound [HalfPedalPoint] TIP If you assign the SONG START/STOP function to a pedal and turn the function On, the pedal function assigned to the pedal in the Voice Setting menu (pages 75 and 76) is disabled. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO YES C Select a pedal to assign the function. Here you can specify the point to which you must depress the pedal (right, center, left, AUX) before the assigned effect begins to be applied. (This setting applies to effects that can be assigned to each pedal, such as damper or sostenuto (page 75). Expression is not affected by this setting.) If the effect is an on/off type effect, this setting specifies the point at which the effect will be switched on/off. A D Set to On or Off. B NO Setting for: C YES D Left, Middle, AUX Setting range: Setting range: –2 (effective with the shallowest press) - 0 - +2 (effective with the deepest press) On/Off Normal setting: Pitch bend range [PitchBendRange] Off for all pedals Selecting a type of auxiliary pedal [AuxPedalType] A pedal connected to the [AUX PEDAL] connector may switch on and off differently. For example, some pedals turn on the effects and others turn them off when you press them. Use this parameter to reverse this mechanism. See the procedure on page 63. A This specifies the amount of change that can be produced by the pitch bend function which smoothly varies the pitch. • This setting applies only to the manually-played sound. • This setting can be made in semitone steps. • You can set the pedal function (page 75) to specify whether the pitch will be raised or lowered. See the procedure on page 63. B A NO B YES NO C YES D C D Setting range: Make, Break Setting range: 0–+12 (Pressing the pedal will raise/lower the pitch by 12 semitones [1 octave]) Normal setting: –2 84 PF-500 Other settings Switch the speaker on/off [Speaker] Restoring the normal (default) settings [FactorySet] This setting lets you switch the speaker on/off. See the procedure on page 63. Normal (HeadphoneSW) The speaker will sound only if headphones are not connected. On The speaker will always sound. Off The speaker will not sound. You can reset the PF-500 to its normal (factory default) settings. • The CharacterCode parameter setting in the File menu does not change. • The MemoryBackUp parameter setting (On/ Off) (left column) is reset to the normal setting. • You can specify whether the memory songs are erased or kept. See the procedure on page 63. Reset the PF-500. A B NO Selecting items saved at shutdown [MemoryBackUp] You can back up some settings, such as voice selection and metronome setting, so that they will not be lost after you turn off the power to the PF-500. • Memory songs (saved in the PF-500’s memory), the backup on/off setting (this parameter setting), and the “CharacterCode” parameter setting (page 47) are always backed up. See the procedure on page 63. A B NO C Select the desired item. YES D Select on or off. Setting for: Transpose, Brilliance, ReverbOnOff, SplitPoint, Main/LeftVoice, MetronomeSetting, SongSetting, MidiSetting, and OtherSetting (except for Transpose and SplitPoint setting). C YES D Select a value for memory songs. Selecting for “MemorySong”: MemorySongExcluded MemorySongIncluded Memory songs are kept. Memory songs are erased. Other method for restoring the normal settings Press and hold down the white key on the right end (C7) and press the [POWER] switch to turn on the power to the PF-500. In this case, the Memory songs saved in the storage memory are not erased. If you wish to erase Memory songs at this time, press and hold down the right-most white key (C7) and black key (B6) and press the [POWER] switch to turn on the power to the PF-500. REVERB CHORUS BRILLIANCE MELLOW BRIGHT MIDI SETTING B 6 OTHER SETTING EFFECT Setting range: On/Off Normal setting: The Transpose, Main/LeftVoice, MetronomeSetting, and OtherSetting (except for Transpose and SplitPoint setting) parameters are set to Off. Other parameters are set to On. POWER ON OFF [POWER] C7 PF-500 85 Message List The messages are listed in alphabetical order. Message Meaning This will be displayed following the “BulkDataReceiving Voice” message. This indicates that the PF-500 finished receiving the bulk data. Once you have verified this message, you may proceed to the next step. Receiving bulk data has failed. Check the parameter settings and try again. The PF-500 is receiving the voice setting bulk data while this message is displayed. Wait until the message disappears, then proceed to the next step. This message confirms that in the “VoiceBulkDump” operation (page 80), you pressed B [–(NO)] to cancel while data was being transmitted. This message is displayed following the message “Executing.” The PF-500’s internal processing is complete. You may proceed to the next step. When you attempted to rename a song and save it in “RenameSong” (page 47), this message will appear if an identically-named song already exists in the strage memory. Three seconds after this message is displayed, you will return to the previous screen. Please specify a different name. This message prompts you to execute a file-related operation. Press the B [+ (YES)] button to proceed, or press the [EXIT] button to cancel. The PF-500 is processing the data internally. Wait until the message disappears, then proceed to the next step. The normal (factory default) settings (except for the memory song setting) (“FactorySet” on page 85) have been restored. This message also appears if you press and hold down the C7 key and turn on the power to the PF-500 (page 85). The normal (factory default) settings (including the memory song setting) (“FactorySet” on page 85) have been restored. This message also appears if you press and hold down the C7 and B 6 keys and turn on the power to the PF-500 (page 85). The PF-500’s flash memory (storage memory) has expired. Consult your Yamaha dealer. If this message appears, the PF-500 will not back up the songs and settings in memory. Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous screen. 86 PF-500 Message List Message Meaning There is a problem with the TO HOST/USB connector When using the PF-500 connected to your personal computer ... The driver or MIDI application on your computer is not functioning correctly, perhaps because the computer is turned off, the cable is not connected correctly, or the HOST SELECT switch is not set correctly. In this case, turn off the power of the PF-500 and your computer, and check the cable connections and HOST SELECT switch setting. Then turn on the power in the order of your computer → PF-500, and check that the driver and MIDI application on your computer are functioning correctly. When using the PF-500 by itself ... This message may appear if a cable is left connected to the [TO HOST] or [USB] connector of the PF-500. In this case, turn off the power of the PF500, disconnect the cable, and then turn on the power again. If the cable is left connected, the PF-500 may not function correctly. You turned off the power to the PF-500 while it was writing a song to storage memory. This message appears next time you turn on the power. The PF-500 checks if the contents of storage memory can be recovered. This message appears following the message “LastPowerOffIllegalMemorySongChecking,” indicating that the PF-500 recovered data in the storage memory as much as possible. This message appears following the message “LastPowerOffIllegalMemorySongChecking,” indicating that the PF-500 could not recover data in the storage memory and that all memory songs were deleted. While a preset song was being read, the PF-500 detected defects in memory. Reset the PF-500 to its normal (factory default) settings with “MemorySongIncluded” (page 85) after you back up all song data. This message indicates that there may be a problem with the memory. If the message appears repeatedly when you continue using the PF-500, back up the song data, then restore the default setting by using “FactorySet” with “MemorySongIncluded” selected (page 85). There is not enough memory space left and you cannot save any more songs. Save or delete some songs in the storage memory, then save new data to memory. This message will appear if there is no song for the “SaveToMemory” (page 45) operation to save. In this case, no song will be saved. You tried to delete a song that does not exist in the storage memory. You cannot delete the song. PF-500 87 Message List Message Meaning This message prompts you to select whether you wish to overwrite the existing data with new data when you add recordings to a song. Press the B [+ (YES)] button to allow overwriting. Press the B [– (NO)] button to cancel. You tried to start playing a song or perform another operation right after you select the song. Wait until the message disappears. You tried to copy or delete data in internally-protected files (such as commercially available music data). You cannot write to, copy, or delete such files. After you load an internally-protected song such as commercially available music data into the PF-500’s Current memory or storage memory, you tried to save the song to a personal computer. You cannot save such a song to a personal computer etc. This message prompts you to select whether you wish to save the edited settings. Press the B [+ (YES)] button to save the settings. Press the [EXIT] button to cancel. You tried to perform another operation before saving the recorded song to storage memory. If you continue the operation, the recorded song will be lost. To delete the new recording, press the B [– (NO)] button. To keep the recording, press the B [+ (YES)] button. The PF500 displays the “SaveToMemory” (page 45) parameter screen. Save the recorded song, then proceed to another operation. 1. This message will appear if a problem is found with the song data when you select a song or while the song is playing. In this case, reselect the song, and try once again to play it back. If the message still appears, the song data may have been damaged. 2. This message will appear if a different “CharacterCode” (page 47) is selected than when you assigned the song name. In this case, switch the “CharacterCode”, re-select the song, and play back. 88 PF-500 Message List Message Meaning 1. This message will be displayed if current memory fills up during recording. Recording will stop automatically at this point. The data that had been recorded up to that point will remain. This message will also be displayed when you attempt to enter Record mode for additional recording if that song already occupies all of current memory. In this case, additional recording will not be possible. If there is an already-recorded track that you do not need to keep, you can use “ChannelClear” (page 66) to delete the unneeded track, so that you will then be able to record the equivalent amount of additional material. 2. This message will be displayed when you select a song if that song is larger than the capacity of the current memory (page 90). This song cannot be loaded into the PF-500, and cannot be played back. Please select a different song. This message will be displayed when you edit a song if that song is larger than the capacity of the current memory (page 90). This song cannot be edited on the PF-500. This message prompts you to start the operation. To start, press the B [+ (YES)] button. Press the [EXIT] button to cancel the operation. This message prompts you to confirm the execution. Press the B [+ (YES)] button to continue. Press the B [– (NO)] button to cancel. This message means that the PF-500 was unable to transmit voice bulk data. If this message appears, make sure that the power of your computer is not turned off, that the cable is connected correctly, that the HOST SELECT switch is set correctly, and that the driver on your computer is functioning correctly. Then try transmitting the data once again. You used a period or space at the beginning of a song name or you tried to change a song name that includes a character (or characters) not supported by the PF-500, and the PF-500 could not process the name. The PF-500 displays the previous screen in three seconds. Rename the song correctly. PF-500 89 Questions about Operations and Functions ■ The buttons do not respond. While you are using a function, some buttons not used for the function are disabled. If the song is playing, stop the playback. Otherwise, press the [EXIT] button to return to the main screen. Then, perform the desired operation. ■ The sound sustains and does not decay when I press the sostenuto pedal. With the voices in the CHURCH ORGAN, JAZZ ORGAN, STRINGS, or CHOIR group, and some voices of [XG] group the sound continues sustaining while you are holding down the sostenuto pedal. ■ Higher or lower notes does not sound correctly when the transpose or octave setting is made. The setting range for the transposition and octave setting is C-2 - G8. (With the normal setting, the PF-500’s 88 keys covers the range of A1 - C7.) If the lowest key is set to a note lower than C-2, it will produce a sound one octave higher. If the highest key is set to a note higher than G8, it will produce a sound one octave lower. ■ How can I return to the recording or song select screen during song recording or playback? Press one of the SONG SELECT [ [ ] buttons once. ] and ■ The tempo does not change even though I recorded with tempo changes. Depending on the timing of tempo changes, the changed tempo may not be recorded. In this case, the recording will be played back at the original tempo. Make tempo changes when the recording track is selected and a red track indicator is flashing. The same trick applies to editing the tempo after recording. ■ Performance in Dual or Split mode is not recorded. Track data is lost unexpectedly. For Dual or Split mode recording, the recording track for the second voice (that is, the voice for the left-hand part) is automatically assigned (page 30). Therefore, if the track already has data, the data will be overwritten during recording. Also, switching to Dual mode or Split mode in the middle of the song is not recorded. Therefore, the notes you played with the second voice (or the notes lower than the Split point) are not recorded. ■ What type of data is recorded? Data recorded in the tracks: • Note data (notes you play) • Voice selection • PF-500 pedals and external pedal on/off • Reverb depth [ReverbSend] • Chorus depth [ChorusSend] • DSP effect depth [DSPDepth] • Sound brightness [Brightness] • Resonance effect setting [Harmonic Content] • Equalizer’s low-range frequency setting [EQ LowFreq.] • Equalizer’s low-range gain setting [EQ LowGain] • Equalizer’s high-range frequency setting [EQ HighFreq.] • Equalizer’s high-range gain setting [EQ HighGain] • Octave setting of the voice [Octave] • Volume setting of each voice [Volume] • Left/right position of each sound [Pan] • Fine pitch adjustment between two voices (Dual only) [Detune] • Volume change in response to playing strength for each voice [TouchSense] Data recorded globally in all tracks: • Tempo • Time signature • Reverb type • Chorus type • DSP effect type You can change all data except for note data after recording. You can change the time signature at the beginning of the song, or at a position in the song to which you move, by using the B [–]/[+] buttons while the song is stopped. 90 PF-500 Questions about Operations and Functions ■ I cannot change the key signature in the song after recording. Press the [TOP] button to locate the top of the song, use the B [–]/[+] buttons to locate the measure in which you wish to change the key signature, then change it. ■ How much data can I record? • Current memory (page 45): About 800KB • Storage memory (page 45): About 750KB ■ The on/off setting of the pedal connected to the AUX PEDAL jack is reversed. Some types of pedals may turn on and off in opposite fashion. Use the “AuxPedalType” parameter (page 76) in the “OTHER SETTING” menu to change the external pedal setting. ■ The song title is not correct. The “CharacterCode” setting may be different than that used when you named the song. Also, if the song was recorded on another instrument, the title might be displayed incorrectly. Use the “CharacterCode” parameter (page 47) in the FILE menu to change the setting. However, if the song was recorded on another instrument, changing the “CharacterCode” parameter setting may not resolve the problem. ■ What is the difference between “TouchSense” and “TouchResponse” MIDI data? “TouchSense” determines the manner and degree to which the volume level changes in response to your touch on the keyboard. The MIDI note-on velocity data is not changed. It changes the volume level at the same velocity data. “TouchResponse” determines the touch sensitivity of an instrument. The MIDI note-on velocity data is changed when you play the keyboard with a consistent touch. PF-500 91 MEMO 92 PF-500 Appendix PF-500 93 Troubleshooting Problem Cause The power of the PF-500 does not turn on. The power cable is not plugged in (check at the PF-500 and at the electrical outlet). Insert the power cable plug firmly into the PF-500 and into the electrical outlet of the correct voltage. (page 15) There is a clicking noise when you press [POWER] to turn the power on or off. This is caused by the electrical power within the instrument. This is not a malfunction. Noise is heard from the PF-500. A portable telephone is being used near the PF-500 (or the ring tone is sounding). The overall volume is too low. Or, there is no sound at all. The [MASTER VOLUME] is lowered. Headphones are connected (only if the Speaker setting is “Normal HeadphoneSW”). (page 85) Speaker setting is off. Local Control is turned off. “Expression” is assigned to one of the right, center, and left pedals. The keyboard volume is lower than the song playback volume. Sound is still heard from the speakers even though headphones are plugged in. Damper pedal does not function, or notes are sustained even though the damper pedal is not pressed. 94 Solution PF-500 The volume level for the keyboard performance is set too low. Turn off the power of the portable telephone located near the PF-500. Noise may be heard if a portable telephone is used near the PF-500 or if the ring tone occurs. Raise [MASTER VOLUME]. (page 16) Disconnect the headphone plug. Set [Speaker] to “Normal” or “ON”. (page 85) Set Local control ON. (page 79) Assign any function other than “Expression” to the pedal. Move [SONG BALANCE] toward the keyboard to increase the keyboard volume. Speaker setting is On. Set the speaker setting to “Normal (HeadphoneSW)”. (page 85) The plug of the pedal unit is not inserted into the [PEDAL] jack. Insert the plug firmly into the [PEDAL] jack. (page 14) Data Compatibility This section covers basic information on data compatibility: whether or not other MIDI devices can playback the data recorded by PF-500, and whether or not the PF-500 can playback commercially available song data or song data created for other instruments or on a computer. Depending on the MIDI device or data characteristics, you may be able to play back the data without any problem, or you may have to perform some special operations before the data can be played back. If you run into problems playing back data, please refer to the information below. Basic Check Points Sequence Format The data and the MIDI device must match in regards to the items below. • Sequence format • Voice allocation format The system which records song data is called “sequence format.” • Playback is only possible when the sequence format of the disk matches that of the MIDI device. [Common Sequence Formats] ■ SMF (Standard MIDI File) This is the most common sequence format. • Standard MIDI Files are generally available as one of two types: Format 0 or Format 1. • Many MIDI devices are compatible with Format 0, and most commercially available software is recorded as Format 0. • The PF-500 is compatible with both Format 0 and Format 1. • Performance data recorded on the PF-500 is saved in the SMF format 0 in a floppy disk. ■ ESEQ This sequence format is compatible with many of Yamaha’s MIDI devices, including the PF-500 series instruments. This is a common format used with various Yamaha software. • The PF-500 is compatible with ESEQ. PF-500 95 Data Compatibility Voice Allocation Format With MIDI, voices are assigned to specific numbers, called “program numbers.” The numbering standard (order of voice allocation) is referred to as the “voice allocation format.” • Voices may not play back as expected unless the voice allocation format of the song data matches that of the compatible MIDI device used for playback. [Main Voice Allocation Formats] ■ GM System Level 1 This is one of the most common voice allocation formats. • Many MIDI devices are compatible with GM System Level 1, as is most commercially available software. • The PF-500 is compatible with GM System Level 1. ■ XG XG is a major enhancement of the GM System Level 1 format, and was developed by Yamaha specifically to provide more voices and variations, as well as greater expressive control over voices and effects, and to ensure compatibility of data well into the future. • The PF-500 is compatible with XG. • Performance data recorded with preset voices on the PF-500 can be played on other XG-compatible instruments. ■ DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection) This voice allocation format is compatible with many of Yamaha’s MIDI devices, including the PF500 series instruments. This is also common format used with various Yamaha software. The PF-500 is compatible with DOC. • Even if the devices and data used satisfy all the conditions above, the data may still not be completely compatible, depending on the specifications of the devices and particular data recording methods. 96 PF-500 Preset Voice List : YES, ×: No Voice group Voice name Stereo sampling Touch Sense Dynamic sampling Key-off samples String resonance GrandPiano1 This sound was sampled from a full concert grand piano. Three stages of dynamics were sampled, and no effort has been spared in making the sound virtually identical to that of an acoustic piano. Even the tonal changes produced by the damper pedal and the subtle sounds of releasing a key are reproduced. The sympathetic vibration (string resonance) that occurs between the strings of an acoustic piano has also been simulated. Suitable not only for classical compositions but also for piano pieces of any style. MellowPiano A warm and mellow piano sound. Ideal for classical music. RockPiano A bright-sounding piano. Ideal for rock styles. GRAND PIANO1 HonkyTonk Piano GRAND PIANO2 × A honky-tonk style piano. Enjoy a tonal character that is quite different than a grand piano. GrandPiano2 × × × A spacious and clear piano sound with a bright resonance. Ideal for popular music. BrightPiano × × × A spacious and bright piano sound. Ideal for popular and rock music. × × An electronic piano sound produced by an FM synthesizer. The tone will change as you vary your playing touch. Ideal for popular music. × × This voice simulates the electric piano sound produced by synthesizers in popular music. It also goes well with the acoustic piano sound. × The sound of an electric piano using hammerstruck metallic “tines.” Soft tone when played lightly, and an aggressive tone when played hard. × A different type of electric piano sound. Widely used in rock and popular music. E.Piano1 × SynthPiano × E.Piano2 × Vintage E.Piano × E.PIANO1 × E.PIANO2 HARPSI CHORD E.CLAVI CHORD Voice description × Harpsichord 8' × × × The sound of the instrument frequently used in baroque music. Variations in playing touch will not affect the volume, and a characteristic sound will be heard when you release the key. Harpsichord 8'+4' × × × A harpsichord with an added upper octave. Produces a more brilliant sound. E.Clavichord × × × This is the voice of a keyboard that produces sound by striking the strings with magnetic pickups. This funky sound is popular in black contemporary music. Because of its unique structure, the instrument produces a peculiar sound when you release the keys. Wah Clavi. × × × A distinctive effect is preset. × × Vibraphone played with relatively soft mallets. The tone becomes more metallic the harder you play. × × A marimba sound, sampled in stereo for spaciousness and realism. × The sound of a celesta (a percussion instrument in which hammers strike metallic bars to produce sound). This instrument is well-known for its appearance in “Dance of the Sugar-plum Fairies” from Tchaikovsky’s “Nutcracker Suite.” Vibraphone Marimba VIBRAPHONE Celesta × × PF-500 97 Preset Voice List Voice group Voice name Stereo sampling Touch Sense Dynamic sampling Key-off samples String resonance Voice description NylonGuitar × × × × A warm and natural nylon-string guitar sound. Enjoy the atmosphere it adds to a quiet song. SteelGuitar × × × × A bright steel guitar sound. Ideal for popular music. GUITAR CHURCH ORGAN PipeOrgan Principal × × × × This voice features the combination of pipes (8'+4'+2') of a principal (brass instrument) organ. It is suitable for Baroque church music. PipeOrgan Tutti × × × × This voice features a full coupler of a pipe organ, famous for the sound used in Toccatta and Fugue by Bach. PipeOrgan Flute1 × × × × A pipe organ sound that combines flute-type (woodwind type) stops of different pitches (8' + 4'). This is a gentle sound that is ideal for accompanying hymns. PipeOrgan Flute2 JAZZORGAN × × × × × × × The sound of a “tonewheel” type electric organ. Often heard in jazz and rock idioms. RotaryOrgan × × × × × A bright electric organ sound. MellowOrgan × × × × × A mellow electric organ sound. Ideal for calmer songs. × × × Stereo-sampled, large-scale strings ensemble with realistic reverb. Try combining this voice with piano in the Dual mode. × × × A bright and spacious strings sound. Suitable for sustained parts in the background of an ensemble. × × × The sound of a string ensemble, with a slow attack. Suitable for use in Dual mode with GRAND PIANO or E.PIANO. SynthStrings × SlowStrings CHOIR × JazzOrgan Strings STRINGS × A pipe organ sound that combines flute-type (woodwind type) stops of different pitches (8' + 4' + 1-1/3'). This is brighter than PipeOrganFlute1, and is suitable for solos. Choir × × × × A big, spacious choir voice. Perfect for creating rich harmonies in slow pieces. SlowChoir × × × × The sound of a choir with a slow attack. Suitable for use in Dual mode with GRAND PIANO or E.PIANO. Scat × × × You can enjoy jazz “scatting” with this voice. Depending on how hard and what note range you play, different sounds will be produced. SynthPad1 × × × × A warm, mellow, and spacious synth sound. Ideal for sustained parts in the background of an ensemble. SynthPad2 × × × × A clear and spacious synth sound. Ideal for sustained parts in the background of an ensemble. WoodBass × × × × The sound of a finger-plucked upright bass. Frequently used in jazz and Latin music. Bass&Cymbal × × × × The sound of a cymbal has been layered onto the bass. Effective when used for jazz walking-bass lines. ElectricBass × × × × The sound of an electric bass. Frequently used in jazz, rock, and popular music. FretlessBass × × × × The sound of a fretless bass. Suitable for styles such as jazz and fusion. SYNTH.PAD WOOD BASS E.BASS 98 PF-500 Voice Combination Examples (Dual and Split) Dual MAIN + MAIN GrandPiano1 + E.Piano1 GrandPiano1 + E.Piano2 GrandPiano1 + SynthPiano MAIN + MAIN GrandPiano2 + GrandPiano2 MAIN + MAIN E.Piano1 + SlowChoir MAIN + MAIN E.Piano2 + E.Clavichord MAIN + MAIN Harpsichord8' + Strings MAIN + MAIN Celesta + SynthStirngs MAIN + MAIN This combination is often used in popular music. This produces a fantasy, spacious piano sound. This combination sounds as if you are playing two notes that are one octave apart. It is suitable for the accompaniment of Salsa music. This is suitable for romantic ballads. This is suitable for funk, rhythm & blues, and soul music. This combination is very suitable for Baroque music. This combination adds strings and bell sound. A delay effect is automatically applied. Split MAIN / LEFT GrandPiano1 / WoodBass or Bass&Cymbal MAIN / LEFT Celesta / Choir MAIN / LEFT Choir / GrandPiano1 MAIN / LEFT Scat / WoodBass MAIN / LEFT E.Piano2 / Scat This is recommended for light Jazz music. The damper pedal is effective on the voice assigned to the right-hand range. This is suitable for a peaceful, somewhat cute song. Play these voices elegantly along with piano arpeggio. Playing the Choir voice in chords would be more effective. This combination features a cool (stylish) jazz chorus. The Scat voice is touch sensitive, adding a variety of expressions. Playing the Scat voice for a bass part may create an interesting sound. Dual + Split MAIN + MAIN / LEFT GrandPiano1 + SynthString / GrandPiano1 MAIN + MAIN / LEFT GrandPiano2 + E.Piano1 / ElectricBass MAIN + MAIN / LEFT + LEFT Harpsichord8' + 4' + Strings / Harpsichord8' + Strings This combination creates the thick sound of a layered piano and strings. This sound is suitable for fusion. Deeper reverb and chorus (page 71) will improve the groove. The damper pedal is effective on the voice assigned to the right-hand range. This combination makes a very brilliant sound. PF-500 99 Assembling the Keyboard Stand You can use the PF-500 without installing the stand. However, if you wish to attach the stand to the PF-500, follow the steps below. CAUTION • Be careful not to confuse parts. Make sure that you install all parts in the correct orientation. Assemble the stand in accordance with the steps below. • At least two persons should assemble the stand together. • Be sure to use the correct-size screws, as indicated below. Use of incorrect screws can cause damages to the stand. • When you attach each part, be sure to tighten all screws. • Reverse the assembly procedure to disassemble the stand. 1. Attaching the front legs to the stand. 1 Place the stand on the floor so that the bottom side (with smaller holes) faces up. 2 2 Use a short screw to attach the bracket of the front right leg to the bot3 tom side of the stand. 3 Use two long screws to fix the bracket of the front right leg to the front side of the stand. 4 Attach the front left leg in the same way. Use the included wrench. Keyboard Remove the following parts from the package. 2. Plate Attaching the rear legs to the stand. 1 Stand 2 Rear left leg Rear right leg Front left leg Front right leg Pedal unit AC power cord Long screws (6x65mm) x 8 Cord holders x 2 Short screws (6x20mm) x 8 100 PF-500 3. Attaching the plate. Align the holes on the plate with the holes of the rear side of the bracket on the rear legs, then fix them using four short screws. Screws Cap bolts x 4 3 Attach the rear right leg in the same way. Wrench x 1 1 Use a short screw to attach the bracket of the rear left leg to the bottom side of the stand. 2 Use two long screws to fix the bracket of the rear left leg to the rear side of the stand. Assembling the Keyboard Stand 4. Raising the stand to the standing position. 7. Connecting the pedal unit. 1 Place the pedal unit in front of the rear legs. 2 Use the front legs as support to raise the stand. PEDAL 3 2 Connect the pedal cord plug into the PEDAL jack on the left side of the keyboard, with the arrow on the plug facing up. 3 Attach the cord holders in the position shown in the illustration, and clip the pedal cord to the holders. * You can also clip the power cord to the cord holders. CAUTION Be careful not to pinch your fingers. 5. Mounting the keyboard. 8. Set the voltage selector and connect the power cord to the AC INLET on the keyboard. AC INLET VOLTAGE SELECTOR Be sure to hold the four corners of the keyboard. Mount the keyboard so that the rubber feet on the bottom of the keyboard fall into the holes on the stand. CAUTION Be careful not to pinch your fingers or drop the keyboard. CAUTION Do not hold any part of the keyboard other than four corners as shown in the illustration. 6. Fixing the keyboard. Attach the cap bolts on the bottom of the stand and tighten them with your hand to fix the keyboard. Voltage Selector Before connecting the AC power cord, check the setting of the voltage selector (provided in some locations). To set the selector for 110V, 130V, 220V or 240V main voltages, use a "minus" screwdriver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for your region appears next to the pointer on the panel. The voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped. After the proper voltage has been selected, connect the AC power cord to the AC INLET and an AC wall outlet. A plug adaptor may also be provided in some areas to match the pin configuration of the AC wall outlets in your area. WARNING An improper voltage setting can cause serious damage to the PF500 or result in improper operation. After completing the assembly, please check the following. • Are any parts left over? • Review the assembly procedure and correct any errors. • Is the PF-500 clear of doors and other movable fixtures? • Move the PF-500 to an appropriate location. • Does the PF-500 make a rattling noise when you shake it? • Tighten all screws. • Are the pedal and power cords inserted securely into the sockets? • Check the connections. • If the keyboard stand creaks or is otherwise unsteady when you play the keyboard, refer to the assembly diagrams and retighten all screws. PF-500 101 Index You can search the desired section using not only the terminology in this manual but also commonly-used words. The * mark indicates that the corresponding page includes the terminology explanation in the right column. Numerics 50 Piano Preset Songs 22 Practicing a one-hand part 24 A Adding variation to the sound ➔ Effect function 28 Assembly 100 Assigning the START/STOP function to a pedal 84 AUX IN jacks 51 AUX OUT jacks 52 AUX PEDAL jacks 52 Auxiliary pedal function 76 B E BackUp 85 Bench 11 BRILLIANCE 28 C Center pedal 27 Center pedal function 75 Character Code 47 Characters 47 CHORUS 29 combining two voices ➔ Dual mode 30 Connection Audio 52 computer 53 MIDI 56 Other Components 51 Serial 54 Speaker 51 USB 57 Connectors MIDI IN/OUT/THRU 52, 56 CONTRAST* 16 D Damper (right) pedal 27 Data Compatibility 95 Data type 50 102 Default (Normal) setting* 28 Demonstration tunes 20 Detailed Settings 60 Metronome 68 MIDI 77 Other settings 81 recording and playback 65 voices 69 Display contrast 16 DOWN (TEMPO) 50 Piano Preset Songs 23 metronome 34 Dual Detailed settings 69 Recording 42 Dual mode ➔ combining two voices 30 PF-500 Effect function 28 equalizer 74 EXIT 19 EXTRA TRACKS ➔ the third or more tracks 40 F FactorySet 85 Fast forward 23, 49 FILE* 43 H Headphones 16 HOST SELECT switch 52 J L LCD ➔ Screen 19 Contrast 16 Left pedal 27 Left pedal function 76 List Demonstration tunes 20 Detailed Settings 60 Message 86 Preset Voice 97 M MASTER VOLUME* 16 Memory 43 Memory song 43 MemoryBackUp 85 Message List 86 Metronome 34 Detailed settings 68 METRONOME SETTING 68 MIDI 77 Detailed settings 77 MIDI cables 56 MIDI connectors 53, 56 MIDI driver 54 MIDI SETTING 77 Music stand 14 N New Song 35 Normal setting* 28 O Other settings 81 Jacks AUX IN 51 AUX OUT 52 AUX PEDAL 52 PHONES 16 TO HOST 52, 54 USB 52 K Keyboard stand (assembly) 100 P Pedal Function Auxiliary 76 Center 75 Left 76 Right 75 Pedal unit 14 Pedals 27 Index Personal computer 53 PHONES jacks 16 Playback 50 Piano Preset Songs 22 Demo Songs 21 Recorded Songs 49 Playing back repeatedly (song) 67 Playing back repeatedly (specifying the range) 66 playing two voices ➔ Split mode 32 POWER 15 Practicing a one-hand part (50 preset songs) 24 Preset song memory 43 Preset Voice List 97 R Recording Tape Recorder 52 Recording in Dual 42 Recording in Split 42 Recording Your Performance 35 Re-recording 37 REVERB 29 Rewind 23, 49 Right pedal 27 Right pedal function 75 S Scale 82 Screen 19 Select 50 piano preset songs 22 Demo Songs 21 Recorded Songs 48 Selecting a touch response 81 SETTING metronome 68 Volume 16 SMF (Standard MIDI File) 95 Soft (left) pedal 27 Song Data Type 50 Delete 46 Detailed settings 65 Playing back repeatedly 67 Rename 47 Store 43 SONG [START/STOP] 50 Piano Preset Songs 22 Recorded Songs 49 Recording 36 SONG BALANCE 42 SONG SELECT 50 Piano Preset Songs 22 Recorded Songs 48 Recording 35 SONG SETTING 65 Sostenuto (center) pedal 27 Sound brilliance 28 expression 28 reverberation 29 spread and spaciousness 29 Soundboard reverb 29 Split Detailed settings 69 Recording 42 Split mode ➔ playing two voices 32 Split point 33 Splitting the keyboard range and playing two different voices 32 START/STOP metronome 34 Storage memory 43 StringResonance 83 SustainSampling 83 Synchro Start 50 preset songs 24 Recorded Songs 49 TOP 50 Piano Preset Songs 23 Recorded Songs 49 Recording 36 TouchResponse 81 Track playback on and off 50 TRACK1/TRACK2 50 Piano Preset Songs 24 Recording 35, 39 Troubleshooting 94 Tune 81 Type of characters 47 Type of data (recorded) 90 U UP (TEMPO) 50 Piano Preset Songs 23 metronome 34 USB jack 52 V Voice group buttons 26, 32 VOICE SETTING 69 Voices* 26 Detailed settings 69 Volume Balance (SONG BLANCE) 42 Setting 16 X XG 96 T TEMPO 50 Piano Preset Songs 23 metronome 34 Recorded Songs 49 the third or more tracks ➔ EXTRA TRACKS 40 TO HOST jack 52, 54 PF-500 103 MEMO 104 PF-500 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS INFORMATION RELATING TO PERSONAL INJURY, ELECTRICAL SHOCK, AND FIRE HAZARD POSSIBILITIES HAS BEEN INCLUDED IN THIS LIST. WARNING- When using any electrical or electronic product, basic precautions should always be followed. These precautions include, but are not limited to, the following: 1. Read all Safety Instructions, Installation Instructions, Special Message Section items, and any Assembly Instructions found in this manual BEFORE making any connections, including connection to the main supply. 2. Main Power Supply Verification: Yamaha products are manufactured specifically for the supply voltage in the area where they are to be sold. If you should move, or if any doubt exists about the supply voltage in your area, please contact your dealer for supply voltage verification and (if applicable) instructions. The required supply voltage is printed on the name plate. For name plate location, please refer to the graphic found in the Special Message Section of this manual. 3. This product may be equipped with a polarized plug (one blade wider than the other). If you are unable to insert the plug into the outlet, turn the plug over and try again. If the problem persists, contact an electrician to have the obsolete outlet replaced. Do NOT defeat the safety purpose of the plug. 4. Some electronic products utilize external power supplies or adapters. Do NOT connect this type of product to any power supply or adapter other than one described in the owners manual, on the name plate, or specifically recommended by Yamaha. 5. WARNING: Do not place this product or any other objects on the power cord or place it in a position where anyone could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over power or connecting cords of any kind. The use of an extension cord is not recommended! If you must use an extension cord, the minimum wire size for a 25’ cord (or less) is 18 AWG. NOTE: The smaller the AWG number, the larger the current handling capacity. For longer extension cords, consult a local electrician. 6. Ventilation: Electronic products, unless specifically designed for enclosed installations, should be placed in locations that do not interfere with proper ventilation. If instructions for enclosed installations are not provided, it must be assumed that unobstructed ventilation is required. 7. Temperature considerations: Electronic products should be installed in locations that do not significantly contribute to their operating temperature. Placement of this product close to heat sources such as; radiators, heat registers and other devices that produce heat should be avoided. 8. This product was NOT designed for use in wet/damp locations and should not be used near water or exposed to rain. Examples of wet/damp locations are; near a swimming pool, spa, tub, sink, or wet basement. 9. This product should be used only with the components supplied or; a cart, rack, or stand that is recommended by the manufacturer. If a cart, rack, or stand is used, please observe all safety markings and instructions that accompany the accessory product. 10. The power supply cord (plug) should be disconnected from the outlet when electronic products are to be left unused for extended periods of time. Cords should also be disconnected when there is a high probability of lightning and/or electrical storm activity. 11. Care should be taken that objects do not fall and liquids are not spilled into the enclosure through any openings that may exist. 12. Electrical/electronic products should be serviced by a qualified service person when: a. The power supply cord has been damaged; or b. Objects have fallen, been inserted, or liquids have been spilled into the enclosure through openings; or c. The product has been exposed to rain: or d. The product dose not operate, exhibits a marked change in performance; or e. The product has been dropped, or the enclosure of the product has been damaged. 13. Do not attempt to service this product beyond that described in the user-maintenance instructions. All other servicing should be referred to qualified service personnel. 14. This product, either alone or in combination with an amplifier and headphones or speaker/s, may be capable of producing sound levels that could cause permanent hearing loss. DO NOT operate for a long period of time at a high volume level or at a level that is uncomfortable. If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, you should consult an audiologist. IMPORTANT: The louder the sound, the shorter the time period before damage occurs. 15. Some Yamaha products may have benches and/or accessory mounting fixtures that are either supplied as a part of the product or as optional accessories. Some of these items are designed to be dealer assembled or installed. Please make sure that benches are stable and any optional fixtures (where applicable) are well secured BEFORE using. Benches supplied by Yamaha are designed for seating only. No other uses are recommended. PLEASE KEEP THIS MANUAL 92-469-2 PF-500 105 FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.) 1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT! This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product. 2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to accessories and/or another product use only high quality shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to use this product in the USA. 3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that your use of this product in a residential environment will not result in harmful interference with other electronic devices. This equipment generates/ uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used according to the instructions found in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the operation of other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that interference will not occur in all installations. If this product is found to be the source of interference, which can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the following measures: Relocate either this product or the device that is being affected by the interference. Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s. In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead, change the lead-in to co-axial type cable. If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory results, please contact the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corporation of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA90620 The above statements apply ONLY to those products distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its subsidiaries. * This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA. IMPORTANT NOTICE FOR THE UNITED KINGDOM Connecting the Plug and Cord IMPORTANT. The wires in this mains lead are coloured in accordance with the following code: BLUE : NEUTRAL BROWN : LIVE As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this apparatus may not correspond with the coloured makings identifying the terminals in your plug proceed as follows: The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the letter N or coloured BLACK. The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to the terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured RED. Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth terminal of the three pin plug. (2 wires) • This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha-Kemble Music (U.K.) Ltd. CAUTION: TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH WIDE BLADE OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT. ATTENTION: POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS ÉLECTRIQUES, INTRODUIRE LA LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE LA FICHE DANS LA BORNE CORRESPONDANTE DE LA PRISE ET POUSSER JUSQU’AU FOND. (polarity) • This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha Canada Music Ltd. • Ceci ne s’applique qu’aux produits distribués par Yamaha Canada Musique Ltée. 106 PF-500 (class B) For details of products, please contact your nearest Yamaha or the authorized distributor listed below. Pour plus de détails sur les produits, veuillez-vous adresser à Yamaha ou au distributeur le plus proche de vous figurant dans la liste suivante. NORTH AMERICA CANADA Yamaha Canada Music Ltd. 135 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario, M1S 3R1, Canada Tel: 416-298-1311 U.S.A. Yamaha Corporation of America 6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620, U.S.A. Tel: 714-522-9011 CENTRAL & SOUTH AMERICA MEXICO Die Einzelheiten zu Produkten sind bei Ihrer unten aufgeführten Niederlassung und bei Yamaha Vertragshändlern in den jeweiligen Bestimmungsländern erhältlich. Para detalles sobre productos, contacte su tienda Yamaha más cercana o el distribuidor autorizado que se lista debajo. ASIA ITALY Yamaha Musica Italia S.P.A., Combo Division Viale Italia 88, 20020 Lainate (Milano), Italy Tel: 02-935-771 SPAIN/PORTUGAL Yamaha-Hazen Electronica Musical, S.A. Ctra. de la Coruna km. 17, 200, 28230 Las Rozas (Madrid) Spain Tel: 91-201-0700 GREECE Philippe Nakas S.A. Navarinou Street 13, P.Code 10680, Athens, Greece Tel: 01-364-7111 SWEDEN Yamaha de Mexico S.A. De C.V., Departamento de ventas Javier Rojo Gomez No.1149, Col. Gpe Del Moral, Deleg. Iztapalapa, 09300 Mexico, D.F. Tel: 686-00-33 BRAZIL Yamaha Scandinavia AB J. A. Wettergrens Gata 1 Box 30053 S-400 43 Göteborg, Sweden Tel: 031 89 34 00 ARGENTINA Yamaha de Panamá S.A. Sucursal de Argentina Viamonte 1145 Piso2-B 1053, Buenos Aires, Argentina Tel: 1-4371-7021 PANAMA AND OTHER LATIN AMERICAN COUNTRIES/ CARIBBEAN COUNTRIES Yamaha de Panamá S.A. Torre Banco General, Piso 7, Urbanización Marbella, Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia, Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá Tel: 507-269-5311 EUROPE THE UNITED KINGDOM Yamaha-Kemble Music (U.K.) Ltd. Sherbourne Drive, Tilbrook, Milton Keynes, MK7 8BL, England Tel: 01908-366700 IRELAND Danfay Ltd. 61D, Sallynoggin Road, Dun Laoghaire, Co. Dublin Tel: 01-2859177 GERMANY/SWITZERLAND Yamaha Europa GmbH. Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, F.R. of Germany Tel: 04101-3030 AUSTRIA Yamaha Music Austria Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien Austria Tel: 01-60203900 THE NETHERLANDS Yamaha Music Nederland Kanaalweg 18G, 3526KL, Utrecht, The Netherlands Tel: 030-2828411 BELGIUM Yamaha Music Belgium Keiberg Imperiastraat 8, 1930 Zaventem, Belgium Tel: 02-7258220 FRANCE Yamaha Musique France, Division Professionnelle BP 70-77312 Marne-la-Vallée Cedex 2, France Tel: 01-64-61-4000 YS Copenhagen Liaison Office Generatorvej 8B DK-2730 Herlev, Denmark Tel: 44 92 49 00 FINLAND F-Musiikki Oy Kluuvikatu 6, P.O. Box 260, SF-00101 Helsinki, Finland Tel: 09 618511 Norsk filial av Yamaha Scandinavia AB Grini Næringspark 1 N-1345 Østerås, Norway Tel: 67 16 77 70 ICELAND Skifan HF Skeifan 17 P.O. Box 8120 IS-128 Reykjavik, Iceland Tel: 525 5000 PT. Yamaha Music Indonesia (Distributor) PT. Nusantik Gedung Yamaha Music Center, Jalan Jend. Gatot Subroto Kav. 4, Jakarta 12930, Indonesia Tel: 21-520-2577 KOREA Yamaha Music Korea Ltd. Tong-Yang Securities Bldg. 16F 23-8 Yoido-dong, Youngdungpo-ku, Seoul, Korea Tel: 02-3770-0661 Yamaha Music Malaysia, Sdn., Bhd. Lot 8, Jalan Perbandaran, 47301 Kelana Jaya, Petaling Jaya, Selangor, Malaysia Tel: 3-703-0900 PHILIPPINES Yupangco Music Corporation 339 Gil J. Puyat Avenue, P.O. Box 885 MCPO, Makati, Metro Manila, Philippines Tel: 819-7551 Yamaha Music Asia Pte., Ltd. 11 Ubi Road #06-00, Meiban Industrial Building, Singapore Tel: 65-747-4374 TAIWAN Yamaha KHS Music Co., Ltd. 10F, 150, Tun-Hwa Northroad, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2713-8999 THAILAND OTHER EUROPEAN COUNTRIES Yamaha Europa GmbH. Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, F.R. of Germany Tel: 04101-3030 AFRICA Yamaha Corporation, Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650 Tel: 053-460-2312 MIDDLE EAST TURKEY/CYPRUS Yamaha Europa GmbH. Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, F.R. of Germany Tel: 04101-3030 Yamaha Music Gulf FZE LB21-128 Jebel Ali Freezone P.O.Box 17328, Dubai, U.A.E. Tel: 971-4-881-5868 INDONESIA SINGAPORE NORWAY OTHER COUNTRIES Tom Lee Music Co., Ltd. 11/F., Silvercord Tower 1, 30 Canton Road, Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong Tel: 2737-7688 MALAYSIA DENMARK Yamaha Musical do Brasil LTDA. Av. Rebouças 2636, São Paulo, Brasil Tel: 011-853-1377 HONG KONG Siam Music Yamaha Co., Ltd. 121/60-61 RS Tower 17th Floor, Ratchadaphisek RD., Dindaeng, Bangkok 10320, Thailand Tel: 02-641-2951 THE PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA AND OTHER ASIAN COUNTRIES Yamaha Corporation, Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650 Tel: 053-460-2317 OCEANIA AUSTRALIA Yamaha Music Australia Pty. Ltd. Level 1, 99 Queensbridge Street, Southbank, Victoria 3006, Australia Tel: 3-9693-5111 NEW ZEALAND Music Houses of N.Z. Ltd. 146/148 Captain Springs Road, Te Papapa, Auckland, New Zealand Tel: 9-634-0099 COUNTRIES AND TRUST TERRITORIES IN PACIFIC OCEAN Yamaha Corporation, Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650 Tel: 053-460-2312 HEAD OFFICE Yamaha Corporation, Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650 Tel: 053-460-2445 SY23 PF-500 107 PF-500 Owner's Manual Yamaha Web Site (English only) www.yamahasynth.com Yamaha Manual Library http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/ Before using the PF-500, be sure to read “Precautions„ on pages 3-4. IMPORTANT This document is printed on recycled chlorine free (ECF) paper with soy ink. M.D.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation C 2002 Yamaha Corporation V941880 205APAP1.3-01A0 Printed in Japan Check your power supply Make sure that your local AC mains voltage matches the voltage specified on the name plate on the bottom panel. In some areas a voltage selector may be provided on the bottom panel of the main keyboard unit. Make sure that the voltage selector is set for the voltage in your area. The voltage selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped. To change the setting use a "minus" screwdriver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage appears next to the pointer on the panel. DIC 338
  • Page 1 1
  • Page 2 2
  • Page 3 3
  • Page 4 4
  • Page 5 5
  • Page 6 6
  • Page 7 7
  • Page 8 8
  • Page 9 9
  • Page 10 10
  • Page 11 11
  • Page 12 12
  • Page 13 13
  • Page 14 14
  • Page 15 15
  • Page 16 16
  • Page 17 17
  • Page 18 18
  • Page 19 19
  • Page 20 20
  • Page 21 21
  • Page 22 22
  • Page 23 23
  • Page 24 24
  • Page 25 25
  • Page 26 26
  • Page 27 27
  • Page 28 28
  • Page 29 29
  • Page 30 30
  • Page 31 31
  • Page 32 32
  • Page 33 33
  • Page 34 34
  • Page 35 35
  • Page 36 36
  • Page 37 37
  • Page 38 38
  • Page 39 39
  • Page 40 40
  • Page 41 41
  • Page 42 42
  • Page 43 43
  • Page 44 44
  • Page 45 45
  • Page 46 46
  • Page 47 47
  • Page 48 48
  • Page 49 49
  • Page 50 50
  • Page 51 51
  • Page 52 52
  • Page 53 53
  • Page 54 54
  • Page 55 55
  • Page 56 56
  • Page 57 57
  • Page 58 58
  • Page 59 59
  • Page 60 60
  • Page 61 61
  • Page 62 62
  • Page 63 63
  • Page 64 64
  • Page 65 65
  • Page 66 66
  • Page 67 67
  • Page 68 68
  • Page 69 69
  • Page 70 70
  • Page 71 71
  • Page 72 72
  • Page 73 73
  • Page 74 74
  • Page 75 75
  • Page 76 76
  • Page 77 77
  • Page 78 78
  • Page 79 79
  • Page 80 80
  • Page 81 81
  • Page 82 82
  • Page 83 83
  • Page 84 84
  • Page 85 85
  • Page 86 86
  • Page 87 87
  • Page 88 88
  • Page 89 89
  • Page 90 90
  • Page 91 91
  • Page 92 92
  • Page 93 93
  • Page 94 94
  • Page 95 95
  • Page 96 96
  • Page 97 97
  • Page 98 98
  • Page 99 99
  • Page 100 100
  • Page 101 101
  • Page 102 102
  • Page 103 103
  • Page 104 104
  • Page 105 105
  • Page 106 106
  • Page 107 107
  • Page 108 108

Yamaha pf50 Handleiding

Categorie
Digitale piano's
Type
Handleiding
Deze handleiding is ook geschikt voor